* breakpoint.c (check_no_tracepoint_commands): Use
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GDB.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include "arch-utils.h"
24 #include <ctype.h>
25 #include "hashtab.h"
26 #include "symtab.h"
27 #include "frame.h"
28 #include "breakpoint.h"
29 #include "tracepoint.h"
30 #include "gdbtypes.h"
31 #include "expression.h"
32 #include "gdbcore.h"
33 #include "gdbcmd.h"
34 #include "value.h"
35 #include "command.h"
36 #include "inferior.h"
37 #include "gdbthread.h"
38 #include "target.h"
39 #include "language.h"
40 #include "gdb_string.h"
41 #include "demangle.h"
42 #include "annotate.h"
43 #include "symfile.h"
44 #include "objfiles.h"
45 #include "source.h"
46 #include "linespec.h"
47 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "gdb.h"
49 #include "ui-out.h"
50 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
51 #include "gdb_assert.h"
52 #include "block.h"
53 #include "solib.h"
54 #include "solist.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "exceptions.h"
57 #include "memattr.h"
58 #include "ada-lang.h"
59 #include "top.h"
60 #include "wrapper.h"
61 #include "valprint.h"
62 #include "jit.h"
63 #include "xml-syscall.h"
64
65 /* readline include files */
66 #include "readline/readline.h"
67 #include "readline/history.h"
68
69 /* readline defines this. */
70 #undef savestring
71
72 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
73
74 /* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers. */
75 #define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
76 #define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
77
78 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
79
80 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
81
82 static void enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
83
84 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
85
86 static void enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
87
88 static void disable_command (char *, int);
89
90 static void enable_command (char *, int);
91
92 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*)(struct breakpoint *));
93
94 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
95
96 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
97
98 static void clear_command (char *, int);
99
100 static void catch_command (char *, int);
101
102 static void watch_command (char *, int);
103
104 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
105
106 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
107
108 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
109
110 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
111 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
112 struct symtab_and_line,
113 enum bptype);
114
115 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
116
117 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
118 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
119 enum bptype bptype);
120
121 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
122 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
123 struct obj_section *, int);
124
125 static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
126 CORE_ADDR addr1,
127 struct address_space *aspace2,
128 CORE_ADDR addr2);
129
130 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
131 struct bp_location *loc2);
132
133 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
134
135 static void breakpoint_1 (int, int);
136
137 static bpstat bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *, bpstat);
138
139 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
140
141 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
142
143 static void commands_command (char *, int);
144
145 static void condition_command (char *, int);
146
147 static int get_number_trailer (char **, int);
148
149 void set_breakpoint_count (int);
150
151 typedef enum
152 {
153 mark_inserted,
154 mark_uninserted
155 }
156 insertion_state_t;
157
158 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
159 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
160
161 static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
162
163 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
164
165 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
166
167 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
168
169 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
170
171 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
172
173 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
174
175 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
176
177 static void watch_command_1 (char *, int, int);
178
179 static void rwatch_command (char *, int);
180
181 static void awatch_command (char *, int);
182
183 static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
184
185 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
186
187 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
188
189 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
190
191 static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
192
193 static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
194 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
195
196 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
197
198 static void ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s);
199
200 static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
201 CORE_ADDR pc);
202
203 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
204
205 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
206
207 static void update_global_location_list (int);
208
209 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
210
211 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
212
213 static int is_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
214
215 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
216
217 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
218
219 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
220
221 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
222
223 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
224
225 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
226
227 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
228
229 static void skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal);
230
231
232 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
233 current breakpoint. */
234
235 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
236
237 static const char *
238 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
239 {
240 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and represent
241 values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at a breakpoint. */
242 static char *bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
243 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
244 }
245
246 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
247 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
248 if such is available. */
249 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
250
251 static void
252 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
253 struct cmd_list_element *c,
254 const char *value)
255 {
256 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
257 Debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
258 value);
259 }
260
261 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
262 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
263 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
264 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
265 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
266 static void
267 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
268 struct cmd_list_element *c,
269 const char *value)
270 {
271 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
272 Debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
273 value);
274 }
275
276 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
277 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
278 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
279 use hardware breakpoints. */
280 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
281 static void
282 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
283 struct cmd_list_element *c,
284 const char *value)
285 {
286 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
287 Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
288 value);
289 }
290
291 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
292 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
293 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
294 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
295 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
296
297 static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
298 static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
299 static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
300 static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
301 always_inserted_auto,
302 always_inserted_off,
303 always_inserted_on,
304 NULL
305 };
306 static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
307 static void
308 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
309 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
310 {
311 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
312 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
313 Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
314 value,
315 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
316 else
317 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), value);
318 }
319
320 int
321 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
322 {
323 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
324 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
325 }
326
327 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
328
329 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
330 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
331
332 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
333 static int overlay_events_enabled;
334
335 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
336 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the current
337 breakpoint. */
338
339 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
340
341 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
342 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
343 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
344 B = TMP)
345
346 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is not
347 provided so update_global_location_list must not be called while executing
348 the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
349
350 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
351 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
352 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
353 BP_TMP++)
354
355 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
356
357 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
358 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
359 if (tracepoint_type (B))
360
361 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
362
363 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
364
365 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
366
367 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
368
369 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
370
371 static unsigned bp_location_count;
372
373 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and ADDRESS
374 for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
375 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
376 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
377
378 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
379
380 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between
381 bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for
382 the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
383 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
384 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
385
386 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
387
388 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint,
389 unlinked from bp_location array, but for which a hit
390 may still be reported by a target. */
391 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
392
393 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
394
395 int breakpoint_count;
396
397 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
398
399 int tracepoint_count;
400
401 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
402 static int
403 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
404 {
405 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
406 }
407
408 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
409
410 void
411 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
412 {
413 breakpoint_count = num;
414 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
415 }
416
417 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
418
419 void
420 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
421 {
422 struct breakpoint *b;
423
424 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
425 b->hit_count = 0;
426 }
427
428 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
429
430 static int
431 tracepoint_type (const struct breakpoint *b)
432 {
433 return (b->type == bp_tracepoint || b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint);
434 }
435
436 /* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
437 for "break" command with no arg.
438 if default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
439 not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
440
441 This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint. */
442
443 int default_breakpoint_valid;
444 CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
445 struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
446 int default_breakpoint_line;
447 struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
448
449 \f
450 /* *PP is a string denoting a breakpoint. Get the number of the breakpoint.
451 Advance *PP after the string and any trailing whitespace.
452
453 Currently the string can either be a number or "$" followed by the name
454 of a convenience variable. Making it an expression wouldn't work well
455 for map_breakpoint_numbers (e.g. "4 + 5 + 6").
456
457 If the string is a NULL pointer, that denotes the last breakpoint.
458
459 TRAILER is a character which can be found after the number; most
460 commonly this is `-'. If you don't want a trailer, use \0. */
461 static int
462 get_number_trailer (char **pp, int trailer)
463 {
464 int retval = 0; /* default */
465 char *p = *pp;
466
467 if (p == NULL)
468 /* Empty line means refer to the last breakpoint. */
469 return breakpoint_count;
470 else if (*p == '$')
471 {
472 /* Make a copy of the name, so we can null-terminate it
473 to pass to lookup_internalvar(). */
474 char *varname;
475 char *start = ++p;
476 LONGEST val;
477
478 while (isalnum (*p) || *p == '_')
479 p++;
480 varname = (char *) alloca (p - start + 1);
481 strncpy (varname, start, p - start);
482 varname[p - start] = '\0';
483 if (get_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar (varname), &val))
484 retval = (int) val;
485 else
486 {
487 printf_filtered (_("Convenience variable must have integer value.\n"));
488 retval = 0;
489 }
490 }
491 else
492 {
493 if (*p == '-')
494 ++p;
495 while (*p >= '0' && *p <= '9')
496 ++p;
497 if (p == *pp)
498 /* There is no number here. (e.g. "cond a == b"). */
499 {
500 /* Skip non-numeric token */
501 while (*p && !isspace((int) *p))
502 ++p;
503 /* Return zero, which caller must interpret as error. */
504 retval = 0;
505 }
506 else
507 retval = atoi (*pp);
508 }
509 if (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
510 {
511 /* Trailing junk: return 0 and let caller print error msg. */
512 while (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
513 ++p;
514 retval = 0;
515 }
516 while (isspace (*p))
517 p++;
518 *pp = p;
519 return retval;
520 }
521
522
523 /* Like get_number_trailer, but don't allow a trailer. */
524 int
525 get_number (char **pp)
526 {
527 return get_number_trailer (pp, '\0');
528 }
529
530 /* Parse a number or a range.
531 * A number will be of the form handled by get_number.
532 * A range will be of the form <number1> - <number2>, and
533 * will represent all the integers between number1 and number2,
534 * inclusive.
535 *
536 * While processing a range, this fuction is called iteratively;
537 * At each call it will return the next value in the range.
538 *
539 * At the beginning of parsing a range, the char pointer PP will
540 * be advanced past <number1> and left pointing at the '-' token.
541 * Subsequent calls will not advance the pointer until the range
542 * is completed. The call that completes the range will advance
543 * pointer PP past <number2>.
544 */
545
546 int
547 get_number_or_range (char **pp)
548 {
549 static int last_retval, end_value;
550 static char *end_ptr;
551 static int in_range = 0;
552
553 if (**pp != '-')
554 {
555 /* Default case: pp is pointing either to a solo number,
556 or to the first number of a range. */
557 last_retval = get_number_trailer (pp, '-');
558 if (**pp == '-')
559 {
560 char **temp;
561
562 /* This is the start of a range (<number1> - <number2>).
563 Skip the '-', parse and remember the second number,
564 and also remember the end of the final token. */
565
566 temp = &end_ptr;
567 end_ptr = *pp + 1;
568 while (isspace ((int) *end_ptr))
569 end_ptr++; /* skip white space */
570 end_value = get_number (temp);
571 if (end_value < last_retval)
572 {
573 error (_("inverted range"));
574 }
575 else if (end_value == last_retval)
576 {
577 /* degenerate range (number1 == number2). Advance the
578 token pointer so that the range will be treated as a
579 single number. */
580 *pp = end_ptr;
581 }
582 else
583 in_range = 1;
584 }
585 }
586 else if (! in_range)
587 error (_("negative value"));
588 else
589 {
590 /* pp points to the '-' that betokens a range. All
591 number-parsing has already been done. Return the next
592 integer value (one greater than the saved previous value).
593 Do not advance the token pointer 'pp' until the end of range
594 is reached. */
595
596 if (++last_retval == end_value)
597 {
598 /* End of range reached; advance token pointer. */
599 *pp = end_ptr;
600 in_range = 0;
601 }
602 }
603 return last_retval;
604 }
605
606 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
607 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
608
609 struct breakpoint *
610 get_breakpoint (int num)
611 {
612 struct breakpoint *b;
613
614 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
615 if (b->number == num)
616 return b;
617
618 return NULL;
619 }
620
621 \f
622 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
623
624 static void
625 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
626 {
627 struct breakpoint *b;
628 char *p;
629 int bnum;
630
631 if (arg == 0)
632 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
633
634 p = arg;
635 bnum = get_number (&p);
636 if (bnum == 0)
637 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
638
639 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
640 if (b->number == bnum)
641 {
642 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
643 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
644 {
645 xfree (loc->cond);
646 loc->cond = NULL;
647 }
648 xfree (b->cond_string);
649 b->cond_string = NULL;
650 xfree (b->cond_exp);
651 b->cond_exp = NULL;
652
653 if (*p == 0)
654 {
655 if (from_tty)
656 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), bnum);
657 }
658 else
659 {
660 arg = p;
661 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
662 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
663 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
664 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
665
666 if (is_watchpoint (b))
667 {
668 innermost_block = NULL;
669 arg = p;
670 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
671 if (*arg)
672 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
673 b->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
674 }
675 else
676 {
677 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
678 {
679 arg = p;
680 loc->cond =
681 parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
682 if (*arg)
683 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
684 }
685 }
686 }
687 breakpoints_changed ();
688 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
689 return;
690 }
691
692 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
693 }
694
695 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
696 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
697 Throw if any such commands is found.
698 */
699 static void
700 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
701 {
702 struct command_line *c;
703 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
704 {
705 int i;
706
707 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
708 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
709
710 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
711 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
712
713 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
714 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
715 command directly. */
716 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
717 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
718
719 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
720 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
721 }
722 }
723
724 int
725 breakpoint_is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
726 {
727 switch (b->type)
728 {
729 case bp_tracepoint:
730 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
731 return 1;
732 default:
733 return 0;
734
735 }
736 }
737
738 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
739 validate that only allowed commands are included.
740 */
741
742 void
743 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, struct command_line *commands)
744 {
745 if (breakpoint_is_tracepoint (b))
746 {
747 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands
748 is valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one while-stepping
749 element, and that while-stepping's body has valid tracing commands
750 excluding nested while-stepping. */
751 struct command_line *c;
752 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
753 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
754 {
755 char *l = c->line;
756 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
757 {
758 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
759 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
760
761 if (while_stepping)
762 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can be used only once"));
763 else
764 while_stepping = c;
765 }
766 }
767 if (while_stepping)
768 {
769 struct command_line *c2;
770
771 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
772 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
773 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
774 {
775 char *l = c2->line;
776 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
777 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
778 }
779 }
780 }
781 else
782 {
783 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
784 }
785
786 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
787 b->commands = commands;
788 breakpoints_changed ();
789 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
790 }
791
792 void check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
793 {
794 struct breakpoint *b = closure;
795 validate_actionline (&line, b);
796 }
797
798 static void
799 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
800 {
801 struct breakpoint *b;
802 char *p;
803 int bnum;
804 struct command_line *l;
805
806 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
807 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
808 being read from. */
809
810 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
811 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
812
813 p = arg;
814 bnum = get_number (&p);
815
816 if (p && *p)
817 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
818
819 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
820 if (b->number == bnum)
821 {
822 char *tmpbuf = xstrprintf ("Type commands for when breakpoint %d is hit, one per line.",
823 bnum);
824 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, tmpbuf);
825
826 if (breakpoint_is_tracepoint (b))
827 l = read_command_lines (tmpbuf, from_tty, 1,
828 check_tracepoint_command, b);
829 else
830 l = read_command_lines (tmpbuf, from_tty, 1, 0, 0);
831 do_cleanups (cleanups);
832 breakpoint_set_commands (b, l);
833 return;
834 }
835 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
836 }
837
838 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
839 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
840
841 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
842 that are part of if and while bodies. */
843 enum command_control_type
844 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
845 {
846 struct breakpoint *b;
847 char *p;
848 int bnum;
849
850 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
851 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
852 being read from. */
853
854 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
855 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
856
857 /* An empty string for the breakpoint number means the last
858 breakpoint, but get_number expects a NULL pointer. */
859 if (arg && !*arg)
860 p = NULL;
861 else
862 p = arg;
863 bnum = get_number (&p);
864
865 if (p && *p)
866 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
867
868 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
869 if (b->number == bnum)
870 {
871 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
872 if (cmd->body_count != 1)
873 error (_("Invalid \"commands\" block structure."));
874 /* We need to copy the commands because if/while will free the
875 list after it finishes execution. */
876 b->commands = copy_command_lines (cmd->body_list[0]);
877 breakpoints_changed ();
878 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
879 return simple_control;
880 }
881 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
882 }
883
884 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
885
886 static int
887 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
888 {
889 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
890 return 0;
891 if (!bl->inserted)
892 return 0;
893 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
894 /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
895 return 0;
896 return 1;
897 }
898
899 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
900 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
901
902 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
903 b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
904 up to b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
905 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
906 memaddr ... memaddr + len
907 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
908 memaddr + len <= b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
909 and:
910 b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
911
912 void
913 breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
914 {
915 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary search. */
916 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
917
918 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF content. It is
919 safe to report lower value but a failure to report higher one. */
920
921 bc_l = 0;
922 bc_r = bp_location_count;
923 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
924 {
925 struct bp_location *b;
926
927 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
928 b = bp_location[bc];
929
930 /* Check first B->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added constant.
931 Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure the BC element can
932 in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR to MEMADDR + LEN range).
933
934 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety offset so that
935 we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow range tail still reaching
936 MEMADDR. */
937
938 if (b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max >= b->address
939 && b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr)
940 bc_l = bc;
941 else
942 bc_r = bc;
943 }
944
945 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
946
947 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
948 {
949 struct bp_location *b = bp_location[bc];
950 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
951 int bp_size = 0;
952 int bptoffset = 0;
953
954 if (b->owner->type == bp_none)
955 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
956 b->owner->number);
957
958 /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
959 content. */
960
961 if (b->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
962 && memaddr + len <= b->address
963 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
964 break;
965
966 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (b))
967 continue;
968 if (!breakpoint_address_match (b->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
969 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
970 continue;
971
972 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
973 we need to copy. */
974 bp_addr = b->target_info.placed_address;
975 bp_size = b->target_info.shadow_len;
976
977 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
978 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
979 are reading. */
980 continue;
981
982 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
983 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
984 reading. */
985 continue;
986
987 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
988 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
989 {
990 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
991 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
992 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
993 bp_addr = memaddr;
994 }
995
996 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
997 {
998 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
999 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1000 }
1001
1002 memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1003 b->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1004 }
1005 }
1006 \f
1007
1008 /* A wrapper function for inserting catchpoints. */
1009 static void
1010 insert_catchpoint (struct ui_out *uo, void *args)
1011 {
1012 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) args;
1013 int val = -1;
1014
1015 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
1016 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->insert != NULL);
1017
1018 b->ops->insert (b);
1019 }
1020
1021 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1022
1023 static int
1024 is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
1025 {
1026 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1027 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1028 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1029 }
1030
1031 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1032 software. */
1033
1034 static int
1035 is_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
1036 {
1037 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1038 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1039 }
1040
1041 /* Find the current value of a watchpoint on EXP. Return the value in
1042 *VALP and *RESULTP and the chain of intermediate and final values
1043 in *VAL_CHAIN. RESULTP and VAL_CHAIN may be NULL if the caller does
1044 not need them.
1045
1046 If a memory error occurs while evaluating the expression, *RESULTP will
1047 be set to NULL. *RESULTP may be a lazy value, if the result could
1048 not be read from memory. It is used to determine whether a value
1049 is user-specified (we should watch the whole value) or intermediate
1050 (we should watch only the bit used to locate the final value).
1051
1052 If the final value, or any intermediate value, could not be read
1053 from memory, *VALP will be set to NULL. *VAL_CHAIN will still be
1054 set to any referenced values. *VALP will never be a lazy value.
1055 This is the value which we store in struct breakpoint.
1056
1057 If VAL_CHAIN is non-NULL, *VAL_CHAIN will be released from the
1058 value chain. The caller must free the values individually. If
1059 VAL_CHAIN is NULL, all generated values will be left on the value
1060 chain. */
1061
1062 static void
1063 fetch_watchpoint_value (struct expression *exp, struct value **valp,
1064 struct value **resultp, struct value **val_chain)
1065 {
1066 struct value *mark, *new_mark, *result;
1067 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
1068
1069 *valp = NULL;
1070 if (resultp)
1071 *resultp = NULL;
1072 if (val_chain)
1073 *val_chain = NULL;
1074
1075 /* Evaluate the expression. */
1076 mark = value_mark ();
1077 result = NULL;
1078
1079 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
1080 {
1081 result = evaluate_expression (exp);
1082 }
1083 if (ex.reason < 0)
1084 {
1085 /* Ignore memory errors, we want watchpoints pointing at
1086 inaccessible memory to still be created; otherwise, throw the
1087 error to some higher catcher. */
1088 switch (ex.error)
1089 {
1090 case MEMORY_ERROR:
1091 break;
1092 default:
1093 throw_exception (ex);
1094 break;
1095 }
1096 }
1097
1098 new_mark = value_mark ();
1099 if (mark == new_mark)
1100 return;
1101 if (resultp)
1102 *resultp = result;
1103
1104 /* Make sure it's not lazy, so that after the target stops again we
1105 have a non-lazy previous value to compare with. */
1106 if (result != NULL
1107 && (!value_lazy (result) || gdb_value_fetch_lazy (result)))
1108 *valp = result;
1109
1110 if (val_chain)
1111 {
1112 /* Return the chain of intermediate values. We use this to
1113 decide which addresses to watch. */
1114 *val_chain = new_mark;
1115 value_release_to_mark (mark);
1116 }
1117 }
1118
1119 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
1120 and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
1121 Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
1122 context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
1123 created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
1124 the correct frame context. Watchpoints on global expressions can
1125 be evaluated on any thread, and in any state. It is presently left
1126 to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
1127 running. */
1128
1129 static int
1130 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1131 {
1132 return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1133 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1134 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1135 }
1136
1137 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1138 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1139 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1140 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1141 in b->loc->cond.
1142 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1143
1144 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do nothing.
1145 If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete it.
1146
1147 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are removed
1148 + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must never be removed
1149 because they might be missed by a running thread when debugging in non-stop
1150 mode. On the other hand, hardware watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint;
1151 processed here) are specific to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's
1152 hardware debug registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in
1153 order to be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1154
1155 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being presented to the
1156 user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would reset the data used to
1157 present the watchpoint hit to the user. And it must not be done later
1158 because it could display the same single watchpoint hit during multiple GDB
1159 stops. Note that the latter is relevant only to the hardware watchpoint
1160 types bp_read_watchpoint and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by
1161 bp_hardware_watchpoint is not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the
1162 memory content has not changed.
1163
1164 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset hardware
1165 watchpoints:
1166
1167 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are called
1168 several times when GDB stops.
1169
1170 [linux]
1171 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, causing GDB to
1172 stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint hit at a time as the
1173 reason for stopping, and all the other hits are presented later, one after
1174 the other, each time the user requests the execution to be resumed.
1175 Execution is not resumed for the threads still having pending hit event
1176 stored in LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1177 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being reported
1178 from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address until the real
1179 thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets presented and thus its
1180 LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1181
1182 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the watchpoint
1183 removal from inferior. */
1184
1185 static void
1186 update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1187 {
1188 int within_current_scope;
1189 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1190 struct bp_location *loc;
1191 int frame_saved;
1192 bpstat bs;
1193
1194 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1195 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1196 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1197 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1198 return;
1199
1200 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in bp_location array and
1201 update_global_locations will eventually delete them and remove
1202 breakpoints if needed. */
1203 b->loc = NULL;
1204
1205 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1206 return;
1207
1208 frame_saved = 0;
1209
1210 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1211 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1212 within_current_scope = 1;
1213 else
1214 {
1215 struct frame_info *fi;
1216
1217 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1218 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1219 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1220 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1221 selected frame. */
1222 frame_saved = 1;
1223 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1224
1225 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1226 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1227 if (within_current_scope)
1228 select_frame (fi);
1229 }
1230
1231 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1232 {
1233 char *s;
1234 if (b->exp)
1235 {
1236 xfree (b->exp);
1237 b->exp = NULL;
1238 }
1239 s = b->exp_string;
1240 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1241 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1242 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1243 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1244 be completely different objects. */
1245 value_free (b->val);
1246 b->val = NULL;
1247 b->val_valid = 0;
1248
1249 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1250 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1251 locations (re)created below. */
1252 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1253 {
1254 if (b->cond_exp != NULL)
1255 {
1256 xfree (b->cond_exp);
1257 b->cond_exp = NULL;
1258 }
1259
1260 s = b->cond_string;
1261 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1262 }
1263 }
1264
1265 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1266 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1267 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1268 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1269 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1270 if ( !target_has_execution)
1271 {
1272 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1273 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1274 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1275 }
1276 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1277 {
1278 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1279 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1280
1281 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1282
1283 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1284 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1285 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1286 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. */
1287 if (!b->val_valid)
1288 {
1289 b->val = v;
1290 b->val_valid = 1;
1291 }
1292
1293 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or an
1294 ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and free
1295 hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior is started. */
1296 if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1297 && reparse)
1298 {
1299 int i, mem_cnt, other_type_used;
1300
1301 /* We need to determine how many resources are already used
1302 for all other hardware watchpoints to see if we still have
1303 enough resources to also fit this watchpoint in as well.
1304 To avoid the hw_watchpoint_used_count call below from counting
1305 this watchpoint, make sure that it is marked as a software
1306 watchpoint. */
1307 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1308 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1309 &other_type_used);
1310 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1311
1312 if (!mem_cnt)
1313 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1314 else
1315 {
1316 int target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1317 (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i + mem_cnt, other_type_used);
1318 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1319 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1320 else
1321 b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1322 }
1323 }
1324
1325 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1326
1327 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1328 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1329 {
1330 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1331 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1332 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1333 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1334 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1335 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1336 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1337 {
1338 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1339
1340 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1341 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1342 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1343 if (v == result
1344 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1345 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1346 {
1347 CORE_ADDR addr;
1348 int len, type;
1349 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1350
1351 addr = value_address (v);
1352 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1353 type = hw_write;
1354 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1355 type = hw_read;
1356 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1357 type = hw_access;
1358
1359 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1360 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1361 ;
1362 *tmp = loc;
1363 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1364
1365 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1366 loc->address = addr;
1367 loc->length = len;
1368 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1369 }
1370 }
1371
1372 next = value_next (v);
1373 if (v != b->val)
1374 value_free (v);
1375 }
1376
1377 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1378 above left it without any location set up. But,
1379 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1380 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1381 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1382 {
1383 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1384 b->loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1385 b->loc->address = -1;
1386 b->loc->length = -1;
1387 b->loc->watchpoint_type = -1;
1388 }
1389 }
1390 else if (!within_current_scope)
1391 {
1392 printf_filtered (_("\
1393 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block \n\
1394 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1395 b->number);
1396 if (b->related_breakpoint)
1397 {
1398 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1399 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
1400 b->related_breakpoint= NULL;
1401 }
1402 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1403 }
1404
1405 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1406 if (frame_saved)
1407 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1408 }
1409
1410
1411 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1412 inserted in the inferior. */
1413 static int
1414 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bpt)
1415 {
1416 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner))
1417 return 0;
1418
1419 if (bpt->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1420 return 0;
1421
1422 if (!bpt->enabled || bpt->shlib_disabled || bpt->duplicate)
1423 return 0;
1424
1425 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1426 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1427 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1428 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1429 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1430 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1431 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1432 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1433 if (bpt->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1434 return 0;
1435
1436 /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1437 not by us. */
1438 if (tracepoint_type (bpt->owner))
1439 return 0;
1440
1441 return 1;
1442 }
1443
1444 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BPT is the breakpoint.
1445 Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and DISABLED_BREAKS,
1446 and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1447
1448 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an object-style
1449 method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
1450 static int
1451 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bpt,
1452 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1453 int *disabled_breaks,
1454 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1455 {
1456 int val = 0;
1457
1458 if (!should_be_inserted (bpt) || bpt->inserted)
1459 return 0;
1460
1461 /* Initialize the target-specific information. */
1462 memset (&bpt->target_info, 0, sizeof (bpt->target_info));
1463 bpt->target_info.placed_address = bpt->address;
1464 bpt->target_info.placed_address_space = bpt->pspace->aspace;
1465
1466 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1467 || bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1468 {
1469 if (bpt->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1470 {
1471 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1472 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1473 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1474 Two important cases are:
1475 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1476 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
1477 hardware breakpoint.
1478 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write.
1479 This means we've previously made the location hardware one, but
1480 then the memory map changed, so we undo.
1481
1482 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will
1483 use location types we've just set here, the only possible
1484 problem is that memory map has changed during running program,
1485 but it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
1486 struct mem_region *mr
1487 = lookup_mem_region (bpt->target_info.placed_address);
1488
1489 if (mr)
1490 {
1491 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1492 {
1493 int changed = 0;
1494 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1495
1496 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1497 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1498 else
1499 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1500
1501 if (new_type != bpt->loc_type)
1502 {
1503 static int said = 0;
1504 bpt->loc_type = new_type;
1505 if (!said)
1506 {
1507 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, _("\
1508 Note: automatically using hardware breakpoints for read-only addresses.\n"));
1509 said = 1;
1510 }
1511 }
1512 }
1513 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1514 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1515 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint at readonly address %s"),
1516 paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address));
1517 }
1518 }
1519
1520 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
1521 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1522 || bpt->section == NULL
1523 || !(section_is_overlay (bpt->section)))
1524 {
1525 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
1526
1527 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1528 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1529 &bpt->target_info);
1530 else
1531 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1532 &bpt->target_info);
1533 }
1534 else
1535 {
1536 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1537 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
1538 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1539 {
1540 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1541 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1542 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
1543 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1544 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1545 bpt->owner->number);
1546 else
1547 {
1548 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bpt->address,
1549 bpt->section);
1550 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
1551 bpt->overlay_target_info = bpt->target_info;
1552 bpt->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1553 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1554 &bpt->overlay_target_info);
1555 if (val != 0)
1556 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1557 "Overlay breakpoint %d failed: in ROM?\n",
1558 bpt->owner->number);
1559 }
1560 }
1561 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1562 if (section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
1563 {
1564 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
1565 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1566 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1567 &bpt->target_info);
1568 else
1569 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1570 &bpt->target_info);
1571 }
1572 else
1573 {
1574 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1575 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
1576 return 0;
1577 }
1578 }
1579
1580 if (val)
1581 {
1582 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
1583 if (solib_name_from_address (bpt->pspace, bpt->address))
1584 {
1585 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1586 val = 0;
1587 bpt->shlib_disabled = 1;
1588 if (!*disabled_breaks)
1589 {
1590 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1591 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1592 bpt->owner->number);
1593 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1594 "Temporarily disabling shared library breakpoints:\n");
1595 }
1596 *disabled_breaks = 1;
1597 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1598 "breakpoint #%d\n", bpt->owner->number);
1599 }
1600 else
1601 {
1602 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1603 {
1604 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1605 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1606 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d.\n",
1607 bpt->owner->number);
1608 }
1609 else
1610 {
1611 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1612 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1613 bpt->owner->number);
1614 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1615 "Error accessing memory address ");
1616 fputs_filtered (paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address),
1617 tmp_error_stream);
1618 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1619 safe_strerror (val));
1620 }
1621
1622 }
1623 }
1624 else
1625 bpt->inserted = 1;
1626
1627 return val;
1628 }
1629
1630 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1631 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1632 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1633 && bpt->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1634 {
1635 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1636 bpt->length,
1637 bpt->watchpoint_type);
1638
1639 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
1640 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
1641 if (val == 1 && bpt->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
1642 {
1643 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1644
1645 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
1646 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
1647 of this one. */
1648 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1649 if (loc != bpt
1650 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
1651 && watchpoint_locations_match (bpt, loc))
1652 {
1653 bpt->duplicate = 1;
1654 bpt->inserted = 1;
1655 bpt->target_info = loc->target_info;
1656 bpt->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1657 val = 0;
1658 break;
1659 }
1660
1661 if (val == 1)
1662 {
1663 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1664 bpt->length,
1665 hw_access);
1666 if (val == 0)
1667 bpt->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1668 }
1669 }
1670
1671 bpt->inserted = (val == 0);
1672 }
1673
1674 else if (bpt->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1675 {
1676 struct gdb_exception e = catch_exception (uiout, insert_catchpoint,
1677 bpt->owner, RETURN_MASK_ERROR);
1678 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, "warning: inserting catchpoint %d: ",
1679 bpt->owner->number);
1680 if (e.reason < 0)
1681 bpt->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1682 else
1683 bpt->inserted = 1;
1684
1685 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1686 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1687 so just return success. */
1688 return 0;
1689 }
1690
1691 return 0;
1692 }
1693
1694 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1695 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1696 PSPACE anymore. */
1697
1698 void
1699 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1700 {
1701 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1702 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1703
1704 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
1705 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1706 {
1707 if (b->pspace == pspace)
1708 delete_breakpoint (b);
1709 }
1710
1711 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1712 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
1713 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1714 {
1715 struct bp_location *tmp;
1716
1717 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1718 {
1719 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1720 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1721 else
1722 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1723 if (tmp->next == loc)
1724 {
1725 tmp->next = loc->next;
1726 break;
1727 }
1728 }
1729 }
1730
1731 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1732 removed locations above. */
1733 update_global_location_list (0);
1734 }
1735
1736 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1737 Throws exception on any error.
1738 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1739 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
1740 void
1741 insert_breakpoints (void)
1742 {
1743 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1744
1745 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1746 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1747 update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1748
1749 update_global_location_list (1);
1750
1751 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1752 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
1753 now. */
1754 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1755 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1756 }
1757
1758 /* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1759 remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1760 Both return zero if successful,
1761 or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior. */
1762
1763 static void
1764 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1765 {
1766 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1767 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1768 int error = 0;
1769 int val = 0;
1770 int disabled_breaks = 0;
1771 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1772
1773 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1774 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1775
1776 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1777 there was an error. */
1778 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1779
1780 save_current_space_and_thread ();
1781
1782 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1783 {
1784 struct thread_info *tp;
1785 CORE_ADDR last_addr;
1786
1787 if (!should_be_inserted (b) || b->inserted)
1788 continue;
1789
1790 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if the
1791 thread no longer exists. */
1792 if (b->owner->thread != -1
1793 && !valid_thread_id (b->owner->thread))
1794 continue;
1795
1796 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
1797
1798 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1799 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
1800 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1801 insert breakpoints. */
1802 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1803 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1804 continue;
1805
1806 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1807 &disabled_breaks,
1808 &hw_breakpoint_error);
1809 if (val)
1810 error = val;
1811 }
1812
1813 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint,
1814 remove them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
1815 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1816 {
1817 int some_failed = 0;
1818 struct bp_location *loc;
1819
1820 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1821 continue;
1822
1823 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1824 continue;
1825
1826 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1827 continue;
1828
1829 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1830 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1831 {
1832 some_failed = 1;
1833 break;
1834 }
1835 if (some_failed)
1836 {
1837 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1838 if (loc->inserted)
1839 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1840
1841 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1842 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1843 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1844 bpt->number);
1845 error = -1;
1846 }
1847 }
1848
1849 if (error)
1850 {
1851 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1852 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
1853 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1854 {
1855 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1856 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
1857 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
1858 }
1859 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
1860 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
1861 }
1862
1863 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1864 }
1865
1866 int
1867 remove_breakpoints (void)
1868 {
1869 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1870 int val = 0;
1871
1872 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1873 {
1874 if (b->inserted)
1875 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1876 }
1877 return val;
1878 }
1879
1880 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
1881
1882 int
1883 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
1884 {
1885 struct bp_location *b, **b_tmp;
1886 int val;
1887 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1888
1889 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, b_tmp)
1890 {
1891 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1892 continue;
1893
1894 if (b->inserted)
1895 {
1896 val = remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1897 if (val != 0)
1898 return val;
1899 }
1900 }
1901 return 0;
1902 }
1903
1904 int
1905 remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
1906 {
1907 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1908 int val = 0;
1909
1910 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1911 {
1912 if (b->inserted && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
1913 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1914 }
1915 return val;
1916 }
1917
1918 int
1919 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
1920 {
1921 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1922 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1923 int val;
1924 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1925 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
1926 struct inferior *inf;
1927 struct thread_info *tp;
1928
1929 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
1930 if (tp == NULL)
1931 return 1;
1932
1933 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1934 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1935
1936 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
1937
1938 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1939
1940 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1941 {
1942 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1943 continue;
1944
1945 if (b->inserted)
1946 {
1947 b->inserted = 0;
1948 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1949 &dummy1, &dummy2);
1950 if (val != 0)
1951 {
1952 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1953 return val;
1954 }
1955 }
1956 }
1957 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1958 return 0;
1959 }
1960
1961 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
1962
1963 static struct breakpoint *
1964 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
1965 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
1966 {
1967 struct symtab_and_line sal;
1968 struct breakpoint *b;
1969
1970 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
1971
1972 sal.pc = address;
1973 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
1974 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
1975
1976 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
1977 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
1978 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
1979
1980 return b;
1981 }
1982
1983 static void
1984 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1985 {
1986 struct objfile *objfile;
1987
1988 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1989 {
1990 struct breakpoint *b;
1991 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1992
1993 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1994 if (m == NULL)
1995 continue;
1996
1997 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1998 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1999 bp_overlay_event);
2000 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2001
2002 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
2003 {
2004 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
2005 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
2006 }
2007 else
2008 {
2009 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2010 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
2011 }
2012 }
2013 update_global_location_list (1);
2014 }
2015
2016 static void
2017 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (char *func_name)
2018 {
2019 struct program_space *pspace;
2020 struct objfile *objfile;
2021 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2022
2023 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
2024
2025 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
2026 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2027 {
2028 struct breakpoint *b;
2029 struct minimal_symbol *m;
2030
2031 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (get_objfile_arch (objfile)))
2032 continue;
2033
2034 set_current_program_space (pspace);
2035
2036 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
2037 if (m == NULL)
2038 continue;
2039
2040 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
2041 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
2042 bp_longjmp_master);
2043 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2044 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2045 }
2046 update_global_location_list (1);
2047
2048 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2049 }
2050
2051 void
2052 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
2053 {
2054 struct breakpoint *b;
2055 struct breakpoint *temp;
2056 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
2057
2058 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
2059 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
2060 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
2061 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
2062 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
2063 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
2064 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
2065 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
2066 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
2067 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
2068 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
2069
2070 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2071 {
2072 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
2073 continue;
2074
2075 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
2076 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
2077 {
2078 delete_breakpoint (b);
2079 continue;
2080 }
2081
2082 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
2083 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
2084 {
2085 delete_breakpoint (b);
2086 continue;
2087 }
2088
2089 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
2090 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
2091 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
2092 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
2093 {
2094 delete_breakpoint (b);
2095 continue;
2096 }
2097
2098 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
2099 if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
2100 {
2101 delete_breakpoint (b);
2102 continue;
2103 }
2104
2105 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
2106 after an exec. */
2107 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume)
2108 {
2109 delete_breakpoint (b);
2110 continue;
2111 }
2112
2113 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
2114 {
2115 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
2116 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
2117 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
2118 a new method, and call this method from here. */
2119 continue;
2120 }
2121
2122 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
2123 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
2124 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
2125 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
2126 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
2127 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
2128
2129 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
2130 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
2131 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
2132 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
2133 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
2134 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
2135 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
2136
2137 In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
2138 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
2139 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
2140 let finish_command delete it.
2141
2142 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
2143 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
2144 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
2145 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
2146 solib breakpoints.) */
2147
2148 if (b->type == bp_finish)
2149 {
2150 continue;
2151 }
2152
2153 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
2154 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
2155 a.out. */
2156 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
2157 {
2158 delete_breakpoint (b);
2159 continue;
2160 }
2161 }
2162 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
2163 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
2164 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
2165 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
2166 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
2167 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
2168 }
2169
2170 int
2171 detach_breakpoints (int pid)
2172 {
2173 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
2174 int val = 0;
2175 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
2176 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
2177
2178 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
2179 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
2180
2181 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
2182 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
2183 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
2184 {
2185 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
2186 continue;
2187
2188 if (b->inserted)
2189 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (b, mark_inserted);
2190 }
2191 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2192 return val;
2193 }
2194
2195 /* Remove the breakpoint location B from the current address space.
2196 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2197 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2198 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2199 *not* look at b->pspace->aspace here. */
2200
2201 static int
2202 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2203 {
2204 int val;
2205 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2206
2207 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2208 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2209 return 0;
2210
2211 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2212 This should not ever happen. */
2213 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2214
2215 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2216 || b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2217 {
2218 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2219 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2220 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
2221
2222 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2223 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2224 || b->section == NULL
2225 || !(section_is_overlay (b->section)))
2226 {
2227 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
2228
2229 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2230 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2231 else
2232 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2233 }
2234 else
2235 {
2236 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2237 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2238 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2239 {
2240 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2241 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
2242 */
2243 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2244 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
2245 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2246 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2247 &b->overlay_target_info);
2248 else
2249 target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2250 &b->overlay_target_info);
2251 }
2252 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2253 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
2254 if (b->inserted)
2255 {
2256 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
2257 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2258 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
2259 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
2260 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2261 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2262 &b->target_info);
2263
2264 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2265 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2266 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
2267 else if (section_is_mapped (b->section))
2268 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2269 &b->target_info);
2270 else
2271 val = 0;
2272 }
2273 else
2274 {
2275 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
2276 val = 0;
2277 }
2278 }
2279
2280 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2281 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2282 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
2283 if (val && solib_name_from_address (b->pspace, b->address))
2284 val = 0;
2285
2286 if (val)
2287 return val;
2288 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2289 }
2290 else if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2291 {
2292 struct value *v;
2293 struct value *n;
2294
2295 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2296 val = target_remove_watchpoint (b->address, b->length,
2297 b->watchpoint_type);
2298
2299 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
2300 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (b->inserted))
2301 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2302 b->owner->number);
2303 }
2304 else if (b->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2305 && breakpoint_enabled (b->owner)
2306 && !b->duplicate)
2307 {
2308 gdb_assert (b->owner->ops != NULL && b->owner->ops->remove != NULL);
2309
2310 val = b->owner->ops->remove (b->owner);
2311 if (val)
2312 return val;
2313 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2314 }
2315
2316 return 0;
2317 }
2318
2319 static int
2320 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2321 {
2322 int ret;
2323 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2324
2325 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2326 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2327 return 0;
2328
2329 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2330 This should not ever happen. */
2331 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2332
2333 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2334
2335 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
2336
2337 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (b, is);
2338
2339 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2340 return ret;
2341 }
2342
2343 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
2344
2345 void
2346 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2347 {
2348 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2349
2350 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2351 if (bpt->pspace == current_program_space)
2352 bpt->inserted = 0;
2353 }
2354
2355 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2356 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2357
2358 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2359 between runs.
2360
2361 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2362 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2363 init_wait_for_inferior). */
2364
2365
2366
2367 void
2368 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2369 {
2370 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
2371 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2372 int ix;
2373 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2374
2375 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2376 nothing to do. */
2377 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2378 return;
2379
2380 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2381 {
2382 if (bpt->pspace == pspace
2383 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2384 bpt->inserted = 0;
2385 }
2386
2387 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2388 {
2389 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2390 continue;
2391
2392 switch (b->type)
2393 {
2394 case bp_call_dummy:
2395
2396 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2397 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
2398 rid of it. */
2399
2400 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2401
2402 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
2403
2404 case bp_shlib_event:
2405
2406 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
2407 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
2408 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
2409 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
2410 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
2411
2412 (gdb) file prog-linux
2413 (gdb) run # native linux target
2414 ...
2415 (gdb) kill
2416 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
2417 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
2418 */
2419
2420 delete_breakpoint (b);
2421 break;
2422
2423 case bp_watchpoint:
2424 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2425 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2426 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2427
2428 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
2429 if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2430 delete_breakpoint (b);
2431 else if (context == inf_starting)
2432 {
2433 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value
2434 in insert_breakpoints. */
2435 if (b->val)
2436 value_free (b->val);
2437 b->val = NULL;
2438 b->val_valid = 0;
2439 }
2440 break;
2441 default:
2442 break;
2443 }
2444 }
2445
2446 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
2447 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bpt); ++ix)
2448 free_bp_location (bpt);
2449 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2450 }
2451
2452 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2453 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2454 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2455 match, not program space. */
2456
2457 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2458 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2459 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2460 permanent breakpoint.
2461 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2462 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2463 - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2464 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2465 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
2466
2467 enum breakpoint_here
2468 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2469 {
2470 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2471 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2472
2473 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2474 {
2475 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2476 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2477 continue;
2478
2479 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2480 || bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2481 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2482 aspace, pc))
2483 {
2484 if (overlay_debugging
2485 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2486 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2487 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2488 else if (bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2489 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2490 else
2491 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2492 }
2493 }
2494
2495 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2496 }
2497
2498 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
2499
2500 int
2501 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2502 {
2503 struct bp_location *loc;
2504 int ix;
2505
2506 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2507 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2508 aspace, pc))
2509 return 1;
2510
2511 return 0;
2512 }
2513
2514 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2515 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array mechanism.
2516 This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which are
2517 inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
2518
2519 int
2520 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2521 {
2522 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2523
2524 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2525 {
2526 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2527 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2528 continue;
2529
2530 if (bpt->inserted
2531 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2532 aspace, pc))
2533 {
2534 if (overlay_debugging
2535 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2536 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2537 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2538 else
2539 return 1;
2540 }
2541 }
2542 return 0;
2543 }
2544
2545 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2546 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
2547
2548 int
2549 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2550 {
2551 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2552 return 1;
2553
2554 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2555 return 1;
2556
2557 return 0;
2558 }
2559
2560 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2561 inserted at PC. */
2562
2563 int
2564 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2565 {
2566 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2567 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2568
2569 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2570 {
2571 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2572 continue;
2573
2574 if (bpt->inserted
2575 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2576 aspace, pc))
2577 {
2578 if (overlay_debugging
2579 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2580 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2581 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2582 else
2583 return 1;
2584 }
2585 }
2586
2587 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
2588 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2589 return 1;
2590
2591 return 0;
2592 }
2593
2594 int
2595 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2596 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2597 {
2598 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2599
2600 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2601 {
2602 struct bp_location *loc;
2603
2604 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2605 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2606 continue;
2607
2608 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2609 continue;
2610
2611 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2612 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2613 {
2614 CORE_ADDR l, h;
2615
2616 /* Check for intersection. */
2617 l = max (loc->address, addr);
2618 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2619 if (l < h)
2620 return 1;
2621 }
2622 }
2623 return 0;
2624 }
2625
2626 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2627 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
2628
2629 int
2630 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2631 ptid_t ptid)
2632 {
2633 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2634 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
2635 int thread = -1;
2636 int task = 0;
2637
2638 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2639 {
2640 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2641 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2642 continue;
2643
2644 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2645 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2646 continue;
2647
2648 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2649 aspace, pc))
2650 continue;
2651
2652 if (bpt->owner->thread != -1)
2653 {
2654 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2655 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2656 it is now time to do so. */
2657 if (thread == -1)
2658 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2659 if (bpt->owner->thread != thread)
2660 continue;
2661 }
2662
2663 if (bpt->owner->task != 0)
2664 {
2665 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2666 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
2667 it is now time to do so. */
2668 if (task == 0)
2669 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2670 if (bpt->owner->task != task)
2671 continue;
2672 }
2673
2674 if (overlay_debugging
2675 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2676 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2677 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2678
2679 return 1;
2680 }
2681
2682 return 0;
2683 }
2684 \f
2685
2686 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
2687 in breakpoint.h. */
2688
2689 int
2690 ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2691 {
2692 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2693 }
2694
2695 void
2696 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
2697 {
2698 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2699 value_free (bs->old_val);
2700 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2701 xfree (bs);
2702 }
2703
2704 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
2705 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
2706
2707 void
2708 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
2709 {
2710 bpstat p;
2711 bpstat q;
2712
2713 if (bsp == 0)
2714 return;
2715 p = *bsp;
2716 while (p != NULL)
2717 {
2718 q = p->next;
2719 bpstat_free (p);
2720 p = q;
2721 }
2722 *bsp = NULL;
2723 }
2724
2725 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
2726 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
2727
2728 bpstat
2729 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
2730 {
2731 bpstat p = NULL;
2732 bpstat tmp;
2733 bpstat retval = NULL;
2734
2735 if (bs == NULL)
2736 return bs;
2737
2738 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2739 {
2740 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
2741 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
2742 if (bs->commands != NULL)
2743 tmp->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
2744 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2745 {
2746 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
2747 release_value (tmp->old_val);
2748 }
2749
2750 if (p == NULL)
2751 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
2752 retval = tmp;
2753 else
2754 p->next = tmp;
2755 p = tmp;
2756 }
2757 p->next = NULL;
2758 return retval;
2759 }
2760
2761 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint */
2762
2763 bpstat
2764 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
2765 {
2766 if (bsp == NULL)
2767 return NULL;
2768
2769 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2770 {
2771 if (bsp->breakpoint_at && bsp->breakpoint_at->owner == breakpoint)
2772 return bsp;
2773 }
2774 return NULL;
2775 }
2776
2777 /* Find a step_resume breakpoint associated with this bpstat.
2778 (If there are multiple step_resume bp's on the list, this function
2779 will arbitrarily pick one.)
2780
2781 It is an error to use this function if BPSTAT doesn't contain a
2782 step_resume breakpoint.
2783
2784 See wait_for_inferior's use of this function. */
2785 struct breakpoint *
2786 bpstat_find_step_resume_breakpoint (bpstat bsp)
2787 {
2788 int current_thread;
2789
2790 gdb_assert (bsp != NULL);
2791
2792 current_thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
2793
2794 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2795 {
2796 if ((bsp->breakpoint_at != NULL)
2797 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->type == bp_step_resume)
2798 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == current_thread
2799 || bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == -1))
2800 return bsp->breakpoint_at->owner;
2801 }
2802
2803 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("No step_resume breakpoint found."));
2804 }
2805
2806
2807 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are stopped
2808 at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the remaining
2809 breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be good for
2810 anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
2811 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
2812 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
2813 we set it.
2814 Return 1 otherwise. */
2815
2816 int
2817 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
2818 {
2819 struct breakpoint *b;
2820
2821 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
2822 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
2823
2824 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that
2825 correspond to a single breakpoint -- otherwise,
2826 this function might return the same number more
2827 than once and this will look ugly. */
2828 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at ? (*bsp)->breakpoint_at->owner : NULL;
2829 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
2830 if (b == NULL)
2831 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
2832
2833 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
2834 return 1;
2835 }
2836
2837 /* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed. */
2838
2839 void
2840 bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
2841 {
2842 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2843 {
2844 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2845 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2846 {
2847 value_free (bs->old_val);
2848 bs->old_val = NULL;
2849 }
2850 }
2851 }
2852
2853 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
2854
2855 static void
2856 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
2857 {
2858 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2859 {
2860 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
2861
2862 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
2863 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
2864 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
2865 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
2866 if (tp->in_infcall)
2867 return;
2868 }
2869
2870 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
2871 }
2872
2873 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint command */
2874 static void
2875 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
2876 {
2877 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
2878 }
2879
2880 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at this
2881 location. Any of these commands could cause the process to proceed
2882 beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by checking
2883 the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
2884
2885 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
2886 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
2887 bpstat of the current thread. */
2888
2889 static int
2890 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
2891 {
2892 bpstat bs;
2893 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2894 int again = 0;
2895
2896 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
2897 in bs->commands. */
2898 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
2899 return 0;
2900
2901 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
2902 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
2903
2904 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
2905 bs = *bsp;
2906
2907 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
2908 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2909 {
2910 struct command_line *cmd;
2911 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
2912
2913 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
2914
2915 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
2916 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
2917 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
2918 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
2919 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
2920 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
2921 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
2922 the tree when we're done. */
2923 cmd = bs->commands;
2924 bs->commands = 0;
2925 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_free_command_lines (&cmd);
2926
2927 while (cmd != NULL)
2928 {
2929 execute_control_command (cmd);
2930
2931 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2932 break;
2933 else
2934 cmd = cmd->next;
2935 }
2936
2937 /* We can free this command tree now. */
2938 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
2939
2940 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2941 {
2942 if (target_can_async_p ())
2943 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
2944 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
2945 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
2946 ;
2947 else
2948 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
2949 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
2950 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
2951 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
2952 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
2953 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
2954 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
2955 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
2956 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
2957 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
2958 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
2959 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
2960 with the new stop_bpstat. */
2961 again = 1;
2962 break;
2963 }
2964 }
2965 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2966 return again;
2967 }
2968
2969 void
2970 bpstat_do_actions (void)
2971 {
2972 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
2973 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
2974 && target_has_execution
2975 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
2976 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
2977 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
2978 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
2979 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
2980 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
2981 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->stop_bpstat))
2982 break;
2983 }
2984
2985 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
2986
2987 static void
2988 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
2989 {
2990 if (val == NULL)
2991 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
2992 else
2993 {
2994 struct value_print_options opts;
2995 get_user_print_options (&opts);
2996 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
2997 }
2998 }
2999
3000 /* This is the normal print function for a bpstat. In the future,
3001 much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
3002 by having it set different print_it values.
3003
3004 Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called. It loops
3005 through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
3006 print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
3007 print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
3008 bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
3009
3010 Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
3011 and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
3012 PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
3013 don't print anything else.
3014 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
3015 that something to be followed by a location.
3016 PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
3017 that something to be followed by a location.
3018 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
3019 analysis. */
3020
3021 static enum print_stop_action
3022 print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
3023 {
3024 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3025 struct breakpoint *b;
3026 const struct bp_location *bl;
3027 struct ui_stream *stb;
3028 int bp_temp = 0;
3029 enum print_stop_action result;
3030
3031 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
3032 which has since been deleted. */
3033 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
3034 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3035 bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3036 b = bl->owner;
3037
3038 stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
3039 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
3040
3041 switch (b->type)
3042 {
3043 case bp_breakpoint:
3044 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
3045 bp_temp = bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del;
3046 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
3047 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
3048 bl->address,
3049 b->number, 1);
3050 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
3051 if (bp_temp)
3052 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
3053 else
3054 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
3055 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3056 {
3057 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
3058 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
3059 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
3060 }
3061 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
3062 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
3063 result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3064 break;
3065
3066 case bp_shlib_event:
3067 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
3068 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
3069 to shlib event" message.) */
3070 printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
3071 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3072 break;
3073
3074 case bp_thread_event:
3075 /* Not sure how we will get here.
3076 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
3077 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3078 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3079 break;
3080
3081 case bp_overlay_event:
3082 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
3083 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3084 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3085 break;
3086
3087 case bp_longjmp_master:
3088 /* These should never be enabled. */
3089 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3090 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3091 break;
3092
3093 case bp_watchpoint:
3094 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3095 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
3096 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3097 ui_out_field_string
3098 (uiout, "reason",
3099 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3100 mention (b);
3101 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3102 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
3103 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
3104 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
3105 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
3106 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3107 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3108 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3109 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
3110 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3111 break;
3112
3113 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3114 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3115 ui_out_field_string
3116 (uiout, "reason",
3117 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3118 mention (b);
3119 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3120 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3121 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3122 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
3123 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3124 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3125 break;
3126
3127 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3128 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3129 {
3130 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
3131 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3132 ui_out_field_string
3133 (uiout, "reason",
3134 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3135 mention (b);
3136 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3137 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
3138 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
3139 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
3140 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
3141 }
3142 else
3143 {
3144 mention (b);
3145 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3146 ui_out_field_string
3147 (uiout, "reason",
3148 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3149 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3150 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3151 }
3152 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3153 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3154 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3155 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3156 break;
3157
3158 /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
3159 here. */
3160
3161 case bp_finish:
3162 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3163 ui_out_field_string
3164 (uiout, "reason",
3165 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
3166 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3167 break;
3168
3169 case bp_until:
3170 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3171 ui_out_field_string
3172 (uiout, "reason",
3173 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
3174 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3175 break;
3176
3177 case bp_none:
3178 case bp_longjmp:
3179 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3180 case bp_step_resume:
3181 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3182 case bp_call_dummy:
3183 case bp_tracepoint:
3184 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
3185 case bp_jit_event:
3186 default:
3187 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3188 break;
3189 }
3190
3191 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3192 return result;
3193 }
3194
3195 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
3196 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
3197 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
3198 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
3199 normal_stop(). */
3200
3201 static enum print_stop_action
3202 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
3203 {
3204 switch (bs->print_it)
3205 {
3206 case print_it_noop:
3207 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
3208 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3209 break;
3210
3211 case print_it_done:
3212 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3213 relevant messages. */
3214 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3215 break;
3216
3217 case print_it_normal:
3218 {
3219 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3220 struct breakpoint *b = bl ? bl->owner : NULL;
3221
3222 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3223 print_it_typical. */
3224 /* FIXME: how breakpoint can ever be NULL here? */
3225 if (b != NULL && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3226 return b->ops->print_it (b);
3227 else
3228 return print_it_typical (bs);
3229 }
3230 break;
3231
3232 default:
3233 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3234 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3235 break;
3236 }
3237 }
3238
3239 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
3240 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3241 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. This
3242 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3243 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
3244 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
3245 routine is one of:
3246
3247 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing
3248 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3249 code to print the location. An example is
3250 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3251 the location.
3252 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3253 to also print the location part of the message.
3254 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3255 don't require a location appended to the end.
3256 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3257 further info to be printed.*/
3258
3259 enum print_stop_action
3260 bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3261 {
3262 int val;
3263
3264 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3265 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3266 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3267 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
3268 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3269 {
3270 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3271 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3272 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3273 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3274 return val;
3275 }
3276
3277 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3278 with and nothing was printed. */
3279 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3280 }
3281
3282 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
3283 This is used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3284 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to char * to
3285 make it pass through catch_errors. */
3286
3287 static int
3288 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3289 {
3290 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3291 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3292 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3293 return i;
3294 }
3295
3296 /* Allocate a new bpstat and chain it to the current one. */
3297
3298 static bpstat
3299 bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *bl, bpstat cbs /* Current "bs" value */ )
3300 {
3301 bpstat bs;
3302
3303 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3304 cbs->next = bs;
3305 bs->breakpoint_at = bl;
3306 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
3307 bs->commands = NULL;
3308 bs->old_val = NULL;
3309 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3310 return bs;
3311 }
3312 \f
3313 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
3314 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
3315
3316 int
3317 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3318 {
3319 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3320 CORE_ADDR addr;
3321 struct breakpoint *b;
3322
3323 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3324 {
3325 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
3326 as not triggered. */
3327 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3328 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3329 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3330 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3331 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3332
3333 return 0;
3334 }
3335
3336 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3337 {
3338 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3339 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
3340 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3341 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3342 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3343 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3344 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3345
3346 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3347 }
3348
3349 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
3350 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3351 triggered. */
3352
3353 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3354 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3355 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3356 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3357 {
3358 struct bp_location *loc;
3359 struct value *v;
3360
3361 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3362 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3363 /* Exact match not required. Within range is
3364 sufficient. */
3365 if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3366 addr, loc->address,
3367 loc->length))
3368 {
3369 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3370 break;
3371 }
3372 }
3373
3374 return 1;
3375 }
3376
3377 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3378 because of check_errors). */
3379 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
3380 #define WP_DELETED 1
3381 /* The value has changed. */
3382 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3383 /* The value has not changed. */
3384 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3385 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
3386 #define WP_IGNORE 4
3387
3388 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3389 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3390
3391 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value changed.
3392
3393 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
3394 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
3395
3396 static int
3397 watchpoint_check (void *p)
3398 {
3399 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3400 struct breakpoint *b;
3401 struct frame_info *fr;
3402 int within_current_scope;
3403
3404 b = bs->breakpoint_at->owner;
3405
3406 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3407 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3408 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
3409 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3410 return WP_IGNORE;
3411
3412 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3413 within_current_scope = 1;
3414 else
3415 {
3416 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3417 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3418 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3419
3420 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're still
3421 in the function but the stack frame has already been invalidated.
3422 Since we can't rely on the values of local variables after the
3423 stack has been destroyed, we are treating the watchpoint in that
3424 state as `not changed' without further checking. Don't mark
3425 watchpoints as changed if the current frame is in an epilogue -
3426 even if they are in some other frame, our view of the stack
3427 is likely to be wrong and frame_find_by_id could error out. */
3428 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3429 return WP_IGNORE;
3430
3431 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3432 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3433
3434 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3435 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
3436 if (within_current_scope)
3437 {
3438 struct symbol *function;
3439
3440 function = get_frame_function (fr);
3441 if (function == NULL
3442 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3443 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3444 within_current_scope = 0;
3445 }
3446
3447 if (within_current_scope)
3448 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3449 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
3450 the user. */
3451 select_frame (fr);
3452 }
3453
3454 if (within_current_scope)
3455 {
3456 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a
3457 *long* time before we return to the command level and
3458 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because
3459 we might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
3460
3461 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3462 struct value *new_val;
3463
3464 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3465
3466 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because the latter
3467 coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just the address of the
3468 array instead of its contents. This is not what we want. */
3469 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3470 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
3471 {
3472 if (new_val != NULL)
3473 {
3474 release_value (new_val);
3475 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3476 }
3477 bs->old_val = b->val;
3478 b->val = new_val;
3479 b->val_valid = 1;
3480 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3481 }
3482 else
3483 {
3484 /* Nothing changed. */
3485 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3486 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3487 }
3488 }
3489 else
3490 {
3491 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3492 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3493 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3494 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3495 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3496 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3497 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3498 the first value assigned). */
3499 /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3500 in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3501 will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3502 information here. */
3503 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3504 ui_out_field_string
3505 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3506 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3507 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3508 ui_out_text (uiout, " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3509 which its expression is valid.\n");
3510
3511 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3512 {
3513 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3514 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
3515 b->related_breakpoint = NULL;
3516 }
3517 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3518
3519 return WP_DELETED;
3520 }
3521 }
3522
3523 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3524 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we
3525 should stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
3526 static int
3527 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3528 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3529 {
3530 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3531
3532 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
3533 tracepoints. */
3534 if (tracepoint_type (b))
3535 return 0;
3536
3537 if (b->type != bp_watchpoint
3538 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
3539 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
3540 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint
3541 && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3542 && b->type != bp_catchpoint) /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3543 {
3544 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3545 aspace, bp_addr))
3546 return 0;
3547 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3548 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3549 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3550 return 0;
3551 }
3552
3553 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3554 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3555 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3556 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3557 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3558 (did not match the data address). */
3559
3560 if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3561 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3562 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3563 && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3564 return 0;
3565
3566 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3567 {
3568 if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3569 return 0;
3570 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3571 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3572 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3573 return 0;
3574 }
3575
3576 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3577 {
3578 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3579 if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3580 return 0;
3581 }
3582
3583 return 1;
3584 }
3585
3586 /* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3587 has actually changed, and we should stop. If not, set BS->stop
3588 to 0. */
3589 static void
3590 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3591 {
3592 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3593 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3594
3595 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint
3596 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3597 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
3598 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3599 {
3600 CORE_ADDR addr;
3601 struct value *v;
3602 int must_check_value = 0;
3603
3604 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3605 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3606 watched value. */
3607 must_check_value = 1;
3608 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3609 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3610 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3611 this watchpoint. */
3612 must_check_value = 1;
3613 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3614 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3615 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3616 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
3617 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3618 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
3619 must_check_value = 1;
3620
3621 if (must_check_value)
3622 {
3623 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3624 b->number);
3625 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3626 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3627 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3628 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3629 switch (e)
3630 {
3631 case WP_DELETED:
3632 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3633 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3634 /* Stop. */
3635 break;
3636 case WP_IGNORE:
3637 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3638 bs->stop = 0;
3639 break;
3640 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3641 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3642 {
3643 /* There are two cases to consider here:
3644
3645 1. we're watching the triggered memory for reads.
3646 In that case, trust the target, and always report
3647 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
3648 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
3649 have changed since the last time it was read, and
3650 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
3651 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
3652 old value.
3653
3654 2. we're watching the triggered memory for both
3655 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
3656 happen:
3657
3658 2.1. this is a target that can't break on data
3659 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
3660 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
3661 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
3662
3663 2.2. otherwise, the target supports read
3664 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
3665 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
3666 watchpoint.
3667
3668 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
3669 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
3670 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
3671 changes. This still gives false positives when
3672 the program writes the same value to memory as
3673 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
3674 it for a read), but it's much better than
3675 nothing. */
3676
3677 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
3678
3679 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
3680 {
3681 struct breakpoint *other_b;
3682
3683 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
3684 if ((other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3685 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3686 && (other_b->watchpoint_triggered
3687 == watch_triggered_yes))
3688 {
3689 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
3690 break;
3691 }
3692 }
3693
3694 if (other_write_watchpoint
3695 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
3696 {
3697 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
3698 and the value changed since the last time we
3699 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
3700 Ignore it. */
3701 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3702 bs->stop = 0;
3703 }
3704 }
3705 break;
3706 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
3707 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3708 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3709 {
3710 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3711 the value hasn't changed. */
3712 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3713 bs->stop = 0;
3714 }
3715 /* Stop. */
3716 break;
3717 default:
3718 /* Can't happen. */
3719 case 0:
3720 /* Error from catch_errors. */
3721 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
3722 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3723 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3724 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3725 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3726 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3727 break;
3728 }
3729 }
3730 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
3731 {
3732 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
3733 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
3734 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
3735 anything for this watchpoint. */
3736 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3737 bs->stop = 0;
3738 }
3739 }
3740 }
3741
3742
3743 /* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
3744 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
3745 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
3746 static void
3747 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
3748 {
3749 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3750 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3751 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3752
3753 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
3754 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
3755 bs->stop = 0;
3756 else if (bs->stop)
3757 {
3758 int value_is_zero = 0;
3759 struct expression *cond;
3760
3761 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
3762 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
3763 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
3764 iteration. */
3765 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
3766 b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3767
3768 if (is_watchpoint (b))
3769 cond = b->cond_exp;
3770 else
3771 cond = bl->cond;
3772
3773 if (cond && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
3774 {
3775 int within_current_scope = 1;
3776
3777 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
3778 be a long time before we return to the command level and
3779 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
3780 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
3781 function call. */
3782 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3783
3784 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
3785 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
3786 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
3787 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
3788 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
3789 call site. */
3790 if (!is_watchpoint (b) || b->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
3791 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
3792 else
3793 {
3794 struct frame_info *frame;
3795
3796 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
3797 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
3798 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
3799 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
3800 really matter which instantiation of the function
3801 where the condition makes sense triggers the
3802 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
3803 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
3804 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
3805 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
3806 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
3807 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
3808 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
3809 intuitive. */
3810 frame = block_innermost_frame (b->cond_exp_valid_block);
3811 if (frame != NULL)
3812 select_frame (frame);
3813 else
3814 within_current_scope = 0;
3815 }
3816 if (within_current_scope)
3817 value_is_zero
3818 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
3819 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
3820 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3821 else
3822 {
3823 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
3824 "in the current scope"));
3825 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
3826 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
3827 value_is_zero = 0;
3828 }
3829 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint # */
3830 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3831 }
3832
3833 if (cond && value_is_zero)
3834 {
3835 bs->stop = 0;
3836 }
3837 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
3838 {
3839 bs->stop = 0;
3840 }
3841 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
3842 {
3843 b->ignore_count--;
3844 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
3845 bs->stop = 0;
3846 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't
3847 stop. */
3848 ++(b->hit_count);
3849 }
3850 }
3851 }
3852
3853
3854 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
3855 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
3856
3857 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
3858 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such that:
3859
3860 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
3861
3862 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
3863
3864 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
3865 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
3866 several reasons concurrently.)
3867
3868 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
3869 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
3870
3871 bpstat
3872 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
3873 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
3874 {
3875 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
3876 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3877 struct bp_location *loc;
3878 /* Root of the chain of bpstat's */
3879 struct bpstats root_bs[1];
3880 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
3881 bpstat bs = root_bs;
3882 int ix;
3883 int need_remove_insert;
3884
3885 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS iteration would break across
3886 update_global_location_list possibly executed by
3887 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions's inferior call. */
3888
3889 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3890 {
3891 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3892 continue;
3893
3894 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
3895 {
3896 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first location.
3897 The watchpoint_check function will work on entire expression,
3898 not the individual locations. For read watchopints, the
3899 watchpoints_triggered function have checked all locations
3900 already. */
3901 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
3902 break;
3903
3904 if (bl->shlib_disabled)
3905 continue;
3906
3907 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
3908 continue;
3909
3910 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address matches */
3911
3912 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, bs); /* Alloc a bpstat to explain stop */
3913
3914 /* Assume we stop. Should we find watchpoint that is not actually
3915 triggered, or if condition of breakpoint is false, we'll reset
3916 'stop' to 0. */
3917 bs->stop = 1;
3918 bs->print = 1;
3919
3920 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
3921 if (!bs->stop)
3922 continue;
3923
3924 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3925 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
3926 /* We do not stop for these. */
3927 bs->stop = 0;
3928 else
3929 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
3930
3931 if (bs->stop)
3932 {
3933 ++(b->hit_count);
3934
3935 /* We will stop here */
3936 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
3937 {
3938 if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3939 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3940 update_global_location_list (0);
3941 }
3942 if (b->silent)
3943 bs->print = 0;
3944 bs->commands = b->commands;
3945 if (bs->commands
3946 && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands->line) == 0
3947 || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q",
3948 bs->commands->line) == 0)))
3949 {
3950 bs->commands = bs->commands->next;
3951 bs->print = 0;
3952 }
3953 bs->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
3954 }
3955
3956 /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or dont print. */
3957 if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
3958 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3959 }
3960 }
3961
3962 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
3963 {
3964 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
3965 aspace, bp_addr))
3966 {
3967 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, bs);
3968 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
3969 bs->stop = 0;
3970 bs->print = 0;
3971 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3972 }
3973 }
3974
3975 bs->next = NULL; /* Terminate the chain */
3976
3977 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
3978 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
3979 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
3980 done later. */
3981 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3982 if (bs->stop)
3983 break;
3984
3985 need_remove_insert = 0;
3986 if (bs == NULL)
3987 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3988 if (!bs->stop
3989 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
3990 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner))
3991 {
3992 update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3993 /* Updating watchpoints invalidates bs->breakpoint_at.
3994 Prevent further code from trying to use it. */
3995 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
3996 need_remove_insert = 1;
3997 }
3998
3999 if (need_remove_insert)
4000 update_global_location_list (1);
4001
4002 return root_bs->next;
4003 }
4004 \f
4005 /* Tell what to do about this bpstat. */
4006 struct bpstat_what
4007 bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
4008 {
4009 /* Classify each bpstat as one of the following. */
4010 enum class
4011 {
4012 /* This bpstat element has no effect on the main_action. */
4013 no_effect = 0,
4014
4015 /* There was a watchpoint, stop but don't print. */
4016 wp_silent,
4017
4018 /* There was a watchpoint, stop and print. */
4019 wp_noisy,
4020
4021 /* There was a breakpoint but we're not stopping. */
4022 bp_nostop,
4023
4024 /* There was a breakpoint, stop but don't print. */
4025 bp_silent,
4026
4027 /* There was a breakpoint, stop and print. */
4028 bp_noisy,
4029
4030 /* We hit the longjmp breakpoint. */
4031 long_jump,
4032
4033 /* We hit the longjmp_resume breakpoint. */
4034 long_resume,
4035
4036 /* We hit the step_resume breakpoint. */
4037 step_resume,
4038
4039 /* We hit the shared library event breakpoint. */
4040 shlib_event,
4041
4042 /* We hit the jit event breakpoint. */
4043 jit_event,
4044
4045 /* This is just used to count how many enums there are. */
4046 class_last
4047 };
4048
4049 /* Here is the table which drives this routine. So that we can
4050 format it pretty, we define some abbreviations for the
4051 enum bpstat_what codes. */
4052 #define kc BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
4053 #define ss BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
4054 #define sn BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
4055 #define sgl BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
4056 #define slr BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME
4057 #define clr BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME
4058 #define sr BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME
4059 #define shl BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_SHLIBS
4060 #define jit BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_JIT
4061
4062 /* "Can't happen." Might want to print an error message.
4063 abort() is not out of the question, but chances are GDB is just
4064 a bit confused, not unusable. */
4065 #define err BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
4066
4067 /* Given an old action and a class, come up with a new action. */
4068 /* One interesting property of this table is that wp_silent is the same
4069 as bp_silent and wp_noisy is the same as bp_noisy. That is because
4070 after stopping, the check for whether to step over a breakpoint
4071 (BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE type stuff) is handled in proceed() without
4072 reference to how we stopped. We retain separate wp_silent and
4073 bp_silent codes in case we want to change that someday.
4074
4075 Another possibly interesting property of this table is that
4076 there's a partial ordering, priority-like, of the actions. Once
4077 you've decided that some action is appropriate, you'll never go
4078 back and decide something of a lower priority is better. The
4079 ordering is:
4080
4081 kc < jit clr sgl shl slr sn sr ss
4082 sgl < jit shl slr sn sr ss
4083 slr < jit err shl sn sr ss
4084 clr < jit err shl sn sr ss
4085 ss < jit shl sn sr
4086 sn < jit shl sr
4087 jit < shl sr
4088 shl < sr
4089 sr <
4090
4091 What I think this means is that we don't need a damned table
4092 here. If you just put the rows and columns in the right order,
4093 it'd look awfully regular. We could simply walk the bpstat list
4094 and choose the highest priority action we find, with a little
4095 logic to handle the 'err' cases. */
4096
4097 /* step_resume entries: a step resume breakpoint overrides another
4098 breakpoint of signal handling (see comment in wait_for_inferior
4099 at where we set the step_resume breakpoint). */
4100
4101 static const enum bpstat_what_main_action
4102 table[(int) class_last][(int) BPSTAT_WHAT_LAST] =
4103 {
4104 /* old action */
4105 /* kc ss sn sgl slr clr sr shl jit */
4106 /* no_effect */ {kc, ss, sn, sgl, slr, clr, sr, shl, jit},
4107 /* wp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
4108 /* wp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
4109 /* bp_nostop */ {sgl, ss, sn, sgl, slr, slr, sr, shl, jit},
4110 /* bp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
4111 /* bp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
4112 /* long_jump */ {slr, ss, sn, slr, slr, err, sr, shl, jit},
4113 /* long_resume */ {clr, ss, sn, err, err, err, sr, shl, jit},
4114 /* step_resume */ {sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr },
4115 /* shlib */ {shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, sr, shl, shl},
4116 /* jit_event */ {jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, sr, jit, jit}
4117 };
4118
4119 #undef kc
4120 #undef ss
4121 #undef sn
4122 #undef sgl
4123 #undef slr
4124 #undef clr
4125 #undef err
4126 #undef sr
4127 #undef ts
4128 #undef shl
4129 #undef jit
4130 enum bpstat_what_main_action current_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
4131 struct bpstat_what retval;
4132
4133 retval.call_dummy = 0;
4134 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4135 {
4136 enum class bs_class = no_effect;
4137 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4138 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary breakpoint
4139 which has since been deleted. */
4140 continue;
4141 if (bs->breakpoint_at->owner == NULL)
4142 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4143 else
4144 switch (bs->breakpoint_at->owner->type)
4145 {
4146 case bp_none:
4147 continue;
4148
4149 case bp_breakpoint:
4150 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4151 case bp_until:
4152 case bp_finish:
4153 if (bs->stop)
4154 {
4155 if (bs->print)
4156 bs_class = bp_noisy;
4157 else
4158 bs_class = bp_silent;
4159 }
4160 else
4161 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4162 break;
4163 case bp_watchpoint:
4164 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4165 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4166 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4167 if (bs->stop)
4168 {
4169 if (bs->print)
4170 bs_class = wp_noisy;
4171 else
4172 bs_class = wp_silent;
4173 }
4174 else
4175 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4176 This requires no further action. */
4177 bs_class = no_effect;
4178 break;
4179 case bp_longjmp:
4180 bs_class = long_jump;
4181 break;
4182 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4183 bs_class = long_resume;
4184 break;
4185 case bp_step_resume:
4186 if (bs->stop)
4187 {
4188 bs_class = step_resume;
4189 }
4190 else
4191 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
4192 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4193 break;
4194 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4195 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4196 break;
4197 case bp_shlib_event:
4198 bs_class = shlib_event;
4199 break;
4200 case bp_jit_event:
4201 bs_class = jit_event;
4202 break;
4203 case bp_thread_event:
4204 case bp_overlay_event:
4205 case bp_longjmp_master:
4206 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4207 break;
4208 case bp_catchpoint:
4209 if (bs->stop)
4210 {
4211 if (bs->print)
4212 bs_class = bp_noisy;
4213 else
4214 bs_class = bp_silent;
4215 }
4216 else
4217 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4218 This requires no further action. */
4219 bs_class = no_effect;
4220 break;
4221 case bp_call_dummy:
4222 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
4223 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
4224 bs_class = bp_silent;
4225 retval.call_dummy = 1;
4226 break;
4227 case bp_tracepoint:
4228 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4229 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
4230 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
4231 out already. */
4232 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4233 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
4234 break;
4235 }
4236 current_action = table[(int) bs_class][(int) current_action];
4237 }
4238 retval.main_action = current_action;
4239 return retval;
4240 }
4241
4242 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
4243 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
4244 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
4245
4246 int
4247 bpstat_should_step (void)
4248 {
4249 struct breakpoint *b;
4250 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4251 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
4252 return 1;
4253 return 0;
4254 }
4255
4256 int
4257 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
4258 {
4259 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4260 if (bs->stop)
4261 return 1;
4262
4263 return 0;
4264 }
4265
4266 \f
4267
4268 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
4269
4270 static void print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4271 struct bp_location *loc,
4272 char *wrap_indent,
4273 struct ui_stream *stb)
4274 {
4275 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
4276
4277 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
4278 loc = NULL;
4279
4280 if (loc != NULL)
4281 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
4282
4283 if (b->source_file && loc)
4284 {
4285 struct symbol *sym
4286 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
4287 if (sym)
4288 {
4289 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
4290 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
4291 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
4292 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent);
4293 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
4294 }
4295 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
4296 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
4297
4298 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4299 {
4300 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
4301 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
4302
4303 if (fullname)
4304 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
4305 }
4306
4307 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
4308 }
4309 else if (loc)
4310 {
4311 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb->stream,
4312 demangle, "");
4313 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
4314 }
4315 else
4316 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
4317
4318 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4319 }
4320
4321 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
4322 static void
4323 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4324 struct bp_location *loc,
4325 int loc_number,
4326 struct bp_location **last_loc,
4327 int print_address_bits,
4328 int allflag)
4329 {
4330 struct command_line *l;
4331 struct symbol *sym;
4332 struct ep_type_description
4333 {
4334 enum bptype type;
4335 char *description;
4336 };
4337 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
4338 {
4339 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4340 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4341 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4342 {bp_until, "until"},
4343 {bp_finish, "finish"},
4344 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4345 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4346 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4347 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4348 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4349 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4350 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4351 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4352 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4353 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4354 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4355 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4356 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4357 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4358 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4359 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
4360 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4361 };
4362
4363 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4364 char wrap_indent[80];
4365 struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4366 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4367 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4368
4369 int header_of_multiple = 0;
4370 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4371 struct value_print_options opts;
4372
4373 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4374
4375 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4376 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning
4377 treatment of breakpoints with single disabled
4378 location. */
4379 if (loc == NULL
4380 && (b->loc != NULL
4381 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4382 header_of_multiple = 1;
4383 if (loc == NULL)
4384 loc = b->loc;
4385
4386 annotate_record ();
4387 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4388
4389 /* 1 */
4390 annotate_field (0);
4391 if (part_of_multiple)
4392 {
4393 char *formatted;
4394 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4395 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4396 xfree (formatted);
4397 }
4398 else
4399 {
4400 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4401 }
4402
4403 /* 2 */
4404 annotate_field (1);
4405 if (part_of_multiple)
4406 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4407 else
4408 {
4409 if (((int) b->type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4410 || ((int) b->type != bptypes[(int) b->type].type))
4411 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4412 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4413 (int) b->type);
4414 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptypes[(int) b->type].description);
4415 }
4416
4417 /* 3 */
4418 annotate_field (2);
4419 if (part_of_multiple)
4420 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4421 else
4422 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4423
4424
4425 /* 4 */
4426 annotate_field (3);
4427 if (part_of_multiple)
4428 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4429 else
4430 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4431 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4432 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4433
4434
4435 /* 5 and 6 */
4436 strcpy (wrap_indent, " ");
4437 if (opts.addressprint)
4438 {
4439 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4440 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4441 else
4442 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4443 }
4444
4445 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4446 {
4447 /* Although the print_one can possibly print
4448 all locations, calling it here is not likely
4449 to get any nice result. So, make sure there's
4450 just one location. */
4451 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4452 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4453 }
4454 else
4455 switch (b->type)
4456 {
4457 case bp_none:
4458 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4459 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4460 break;
4461
4462 case bp_watchpoint:
4463 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4464 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4465 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4466 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4467 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4468 is relatively readable). */
4469 if (opts.addressprint)
4470 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4471 annotate_field (5);
4472 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4473 break;
4474
4475 case bp_breakpoint:
4476 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4477 case bp_until:
4478 case bp_finish:
4479 case bp_longjmp:
4480 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4481 case bp_step_resume:
4482 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4483 case bp_call_dummy:
4484 case bp_shlib_event:
4485 case bp_thread_event:
4486 case bp_overlay_event:
4487 case bp_longjmp_master:
4488 case bp_tracepoint:
4489 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4490 case bp_jit_event:
4491 if (opts.addressprint)
4492 {
4493 annotate_field (4);
4494 if (header_of_multiple)
4495 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4496 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4497 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4498 else
4499 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4500 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4501 }
4502 annotate_field (5);
4503 if (!header_of_multiple)
4504 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc, wrap_indent, stb);
4505 if (b->loc)
4506 *last_loc = b->loc;
4507 break;
4508 }
4509
4510
4511 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4512 are several. */
4513 if (loc != NULL
4514 && !header_of_multiple
4515 && (allflag
4516 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4517 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4518 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4519 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4520 {
4521 struct inferior *inf;
4522 int first = 1;
4523
4524 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4525 {
4526 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4527 {
4528 if (first)
4529 {
4530 first = 0;
4531 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4532 }
4533 else
4534 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4535 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4536 }
4537 }
4538 }
4539
4540 if (!part_of_multiple)
4541 {
4542 if (b->thread != -1)
4543 {
4544 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4545 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4546 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4547 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4548 }
4549 else if (b->task != 0)
4550 {
4551 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4552 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4553 }
4554 }
4555
4556 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4557
4558 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4559 {
4560 annotate_field (6);
4561 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4562 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4563 the frame ID. */
4564 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4565 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4566 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4567 }
4568
4569 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4570 {
4571 /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4572 because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4573 that we do not want to expose to the user. */
4574 annotate_field (7);
4575 if (tracepoint_type (b))
4576 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4577 else
4578 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4579 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4580 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4581 }
4582
4583 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4584 {
4585 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4586 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4587 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4588 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4589 }
4590
4591 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4592 {
4593 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4594 if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4595 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4596 else
4597 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4598 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4599 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4600 if (b->hit_count == 1)
4601 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4602 else
4603 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4604 }
4605
4606 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is
4607 mi. FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4608 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4609 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4610 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4611
4612 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4613 {
4614 annotate_field (8);
4615 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4616 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4617 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4618 }
4619
4620 l = b->commands;
4621 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4622 {
4623 struct cleanup *script_chain;
4624
4625 annotate_field (9);
4626 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4627 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4628 do_cleanups (script_chain);
4629 }
4630
4631 if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4632 {
4633 annotate_field (10);
4634 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4635 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4636 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4637 }
4638
4639 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4640 {
4641 if (b->addr_string)
4642 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4643 else if (b->exp_string)
4644 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4645 }
4646
4647 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4648 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4649 }
4650
4651 static void
4652 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4653 struct bp_location **last_loc, int print_address_bits,
4654 int allflag)
4655 {
4656 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc,
4657 print_address_bits, allflag);
4658
4659 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
4660 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
4661 locations, if any. */
4662 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
4663 {
4664 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is
4665 disabled, we print it as if it had
4666 several locations, since otherwise it's hard to
4667 represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
4668 situation.
4669 Note that while hardware watchpoints have
4670 several locations internally, that's no a property
4671 exposed to user. */
4672 if (b->loc
4673 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
4674 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
4675 && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4676 {
4677 struct bp_location *loc;
4678 int n = 1;
4679 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
4680 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
4681 print_address_bits, allflag);
4682 }
4683 }
4684 }
4685
4686 static int
4687 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
4688 {
4689 int print_address_bits = 0;
4690 struct bp_location *loc;
4691
4692 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4693 {
4694 int addr_bit;
4695
4696 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have
4697 an address to print. */
4698 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && loc->watchpoint_type == -1)
4699 continue;
4700
4701 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
4702 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4703 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4704 }
4705
4706 return print_address_bits;
4707 }
4708
4709 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
4710 {
4711 int bnum;
4712 };
4713
4714 static int
4715 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
4716 {
4717 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
4718 struct breakpoint *b;
4719 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
4720 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4721 {
4722 if (args->bnum == b->number)
4723 {
4724 int print_address_bits = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4725 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, print_address_bits, 0);
4726 return GDB_RC_OK;
4727 }
4728 }
4729 return GDB_RC_NONE;
4730 }
4731
4732 enum gdb_rc
4733 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum, char **error_message)
4734 {
4735 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
4736 args.bnum = bnum;
4737 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
4738 an error. */
4739 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
4740 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
4741 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
4742 else
4743 return GDB_RC_OK;
4744 }
4745
4746 /* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
4747 catchpoints, et.al.). */
4748
4749 static int
4750 user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
4751 {
4752 return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
4753 || b->type == bp_catchpoint
4754 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4755 || tracepoint_type (b)
4756 || b->type == bp_watchpoint
4757 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
4758 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
4759 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint);
4760 }
4761
4762 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
4763 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user settable breakpoints.
4764 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non- user settable breakpoints. */
4765
4766 static void
4767 breakpoint_1 (int bnum, int allflag)
4768 {
4769 struct breakpoint *b;
4770 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
4771 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
4772 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
4773 struct value_print_options opts;
4774 int print_address_bits = 0;
4775
4776 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4777
4778 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the
4779 size required for address fields. */
4780 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
4781 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4782 if (bnum == -1
4783 || bnum == b->number)
4784 {
4785 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4786 {
4787 int addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4788 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4789 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4790
4791 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
4792 }
4793 }
4794
4795 if (opts.addressprint)
4796 bkpttbl_chain
4797 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4798 "BreakpointTable");
4799 else
4800 bkpttbl_chain
4801 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4802 "BreakpointTable");
4803
4804 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4805 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
4806 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4807 annotate_field (0);
4808 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
4809 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4810 annotate_field (1);
4811 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 14, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
4812 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4813 annotate_field (2);
4814 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
4815 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4816 annotate_field (3);
4817 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
4818 if (opts.addressprint)
4819 {
4820 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4821 annotate_field (4);
4822 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4823 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4824 else
4825 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4826 }
4827 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4828 annotate_field (5);
4829 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
4830 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
4831 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4832 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
4833
4834 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4835 {
4836 QUIT;
4837 if (bnum == -1
4838 || bnum == b->number)
4839 {
4840 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
4841 allflag is set. */
4842 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4843 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, print_address_bits, allflag);
4844 }
4845 }
4846
4847 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
4848
4849 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
4850 {
4851 if (bnum == -1)
4852 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
4853 else
4854 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoint or watchpoint number %d.\n",
4855 bnum);
4856 }
4857 else
4858 {
4859 if (last_loc && !server_command)
4860 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
4861 }
4862
4863 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
4864 there have been breakpoints? */
4865 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
4866 }
4867
4868 static void
4869 breakpoints_info (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4870 {
4871 int bnum = -1;
4872
4873 if (bnum_exp)
4874 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4875
4876 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 0);
4877 }
4878
4879 static void
4880 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4881 {
4882 int bnum = -1;
4883
4884 if (bnum_exp)
4885 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4886
4887 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 1);
4888 }
4889
4890 static int
4891 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
4892 struct program_space *pspace,
4893 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
4894 {
4895 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
4896 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
4897 {
4898 if (bl->pspace == pspace
4899 && bl->address == pc
4900 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
4901 return 1;
4902 }
4903 return 0;
4904 }
4905
4906 /* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC. This
4907 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
4908 address spaces. */
4909
4910 static void
4911 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4912 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
4913 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
4914 {
4915 int others = 0;
4916 struct breakpoint *b;
4917
4918 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4919 others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
4920 if (others > 0)
4921 {
4922 if (others == 1)
4923 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
4924 else /* if (others == ???) */
4925 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
4926 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4927 if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
4928 {
4929 others--;
4930 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
4931 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
4932 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
4933 else if (b->thread != -1)
4934 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
4935 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
4936 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
4937 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
4938 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
4939 ? " (disabled)"
4940 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
4941 ? " (permanent)"
4942 : ""),
4943 (others > 1) ? ","
4944 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
4945 }
4946 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
4947 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
4948 printf_filtered (".\n");
4949 }
4950 }
4951 \f
4952 /* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
4953 for the `break' command with no arguments. */
4954
4955 void
4956 set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
4957 CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
4958 int line)
4959 {
4960 default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
4961 default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
4962 default_breakpoint_address = addr;
4963 default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
4964 default_breakpoint_line = line;
4965 }
4966
4967 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
4968 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
4969 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
4970 (or use it for any other purpose either).
4971
4972 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will always
4973 have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of
4974 these types to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint at address zero:
4975
4976 bp_watchpoint
4977 bp_catchpoint
4978
4979 */
4980
4981 static int
4982 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4983 {
4984 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
4985
4986 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
4987 }
4988
4989 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
4990 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
4991
4992 static int
4993 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4994 {
4995 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
4996 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
4997 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
4998 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
4999 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
5000 become hw_access locations later. */
5001 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
5002 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
5003 && loc1->address == loc2->address
5004 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
5005 }
5006
5007 /* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
5008 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
5009 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
5010 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
5011
5012 static int
5013 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
5014 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
5015 {
5016 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
5017 || aspace1 == aspace2)
5018 && addr1 == addr2);
5019 }
5020
5021 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
5022 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
5023 represent the same location. */
5024
5025 static int
5026 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
5027 {
5028 int hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
5029 int hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
5030
5031 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
5032 return 0;
5033 else if (hw_point1)
5034 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
5035 else
5036 return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
5037 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
5038 }
5039
5040 static void
5041 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
5042 int bnum, int have_bnum)
5043 {
5044 char astr1[40];
5045 char astr2[40];
5046
5047 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
5048 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
5049 if (have_bnum)
5050 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
5051 bnum, astr1, astr2);
5052 else
5053 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
5054 }
5055
5056 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural constraints
5057 on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address. Note: Very
5058 few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most targets,
5059 this function is simply the identity function. */
5060
5061 static CORE_ADDR
5062 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5063 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
5064 {
5065 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
5066 {
5067 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
5068 return bpaddr;
5069 }
5070 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
5071 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5072 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
5073 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
5074 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
5075 {
5076 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
5077 have their addresses modified. */
5078 return bpaddr;
5079 }
5080 else
5081 {
5082 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
5083
5084 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
5085 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
5086 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
5087
5088 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
5089 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
5090 is required. */
5091 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
5092 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
5093
5094 return adjusted_bpaddr;
5095 }
5096 }
5097
5098 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
5099
5100 static struct bp_location *
5101 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
5102 {
5103 struct bp_location *loc, *loc_p;
5104
5105 loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
5106 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
5107
5108 loc->owner = bpt;
5109 loc->cond = NULL;
5110 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
5111 loc->enabled = 1;
5112
5113 switch (bpt->type)
5114 {
5115 case bp_breakpoint:
5116 case bp_until:
5117 case bp_finish:
5118 case bp_longjmp:
5119 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5120 case bp_step_resume:
5121 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5122 case bp_call_dummy:
5123 case bp_shlib_event:
5124 case bp_thread_event:
5125 case bp_overlay_event:
5126 case bp_jit_event:
5127 case bp_longjmp_master:
5128 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
5129 break;
5130 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5131 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
5132 break;
5133 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5134 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5135 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5136 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
5137 break;
5138 case bp_watchpoint:
5139 case bp_catchpoint:
5140 case bp_tracepoint:
5141 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5142 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
5143 break;
5144 default:
5145 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
5146 }
5147
5148 return loc;
5149 }
5150
5151 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
5152 {
5153 if (loc->cond)
5154 xfree (loc->cond);
5155
5156 if (loc->function_name)
5157 xfree (loc->function_name);
5158
5159 xfree (loc);
5160 }
5161
5162 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
5163 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
5164 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
5165
5166 static struct breakpoint *
5167 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5168 enum bptype bptype)
5169 {
5170 struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
5171
5172 b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
5173 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
5174
5175 b->type = bptype;
5176 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
5177 b->language = current_language->la_language;
5178 b->input_radix = input_radix;
5179 b->thread = -1;
5180 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5181 b->next = 0;
5182 b->silent = 0;
5183 b->ignore_count = 0;
5184 b->commands = NULL;
5185 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
5186 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5187 b->exec_pathname = NULL;
5188 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
5189 b->ops = NULL;
5190 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
5191
5192 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain
5193 so that a list of breakpoints will come out in order
5194 of increasing numbers. */
5195
5196 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
5197 if (b1 == 0)
5198 breakpoint_chain = b;
5199 else
5200 {
5201 while (b1->next)
5202 b1 = b1->next;
5203 b1->next = b;
5204 }
5205 return b;
5206 }
5207
5208 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
5209 static void
5210 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
5211 {
5212 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
5213 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
5214 || tracepoint_type (loc->owner))
5215 {
5216 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
5217 NULL, NULL);
5218 if (loc->function_name)
5219 loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
5220 }
5221 }
5222
5223 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
5224 static struct gdbarch *
5225 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
5226 {
5227 if (sal.section)
5228 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
5229 if (sal.symtab)
5230 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
5231
5232 return NULL;
5233 }
5234
5235 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
5236 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
5237 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
5238 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
5239 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
5240 is also returned as the value of this function.
5241
5242 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
5243 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
5244 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
5245 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
5246 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
5247 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
5248 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
5249
5250 struct breakpoint *
5251 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5252 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
5253 {
5254 struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, bptype);
5255 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
5256 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
5257
5258 loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
5259 if (!loc_gdbarch)
5260 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
5261
5262 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
5263 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
5264
5265 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
5266 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
5267 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
5268 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
5269 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
5270 location that's only been partially initialized. */
5271 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, sal.pc, b->type);
5272
5273 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
5274 b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
5275 b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
5276 b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
5277 b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
5278
5279 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
5280 breakpoint resetting. */
5281 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
5282
5283 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
5284 b->source_file = NULL;
5285 else
5286 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
5287 b->loc->section = sal.section;
5288 b->line_number = sal.line;
5289
5290 set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
5291
5292 breakpoints_changed ();
5293
5294 return b;
5295 }
5296
5297
5298 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
5299 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
5300 void
5301 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
5302 {
5303 struct bp_location *bl;
5304 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
5305
5306 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the code.
5307 Mark all locations as inserted. For now, make_breakpoint_permanent
5308 is called in just one place, so it's hard to say if it's reasonable
5309 to have permanent breakpoint with multiple locations or not,
5310 but it's easy to implmement. */
5311 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5312 bl->inserted = 1;
5313 }
5314
5315 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
5316 if we do a longjmp() in THREAD. When we hit that breakpoint, call
5317 set_longjmp_resume_breakpoint() to figure out where we are going. */
5318
5319 void
5320 set_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5321 {
5322 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5323
5324 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
5325 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
5326 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
5327 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
5328 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5329 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5330 && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
5331 {
5332 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5333 clone->type = bp_longjmp;
5334 clone->thread = thread;
5335 }
5336 }
5337
5338 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
5339 void
5340 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5341 {
5342 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5343
5344 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5345 if (b->type == bp_longjmp)
5346 {
5347 if (b->thread == thread)
5348 delete_breakpoint (b);
5349 }
5350 }
5351
5352 void
5353 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5354 {
5355 struct breakpoint *b;
5356
5357 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5358 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5359 {
5360 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5361 update_global_location_list (1);
5362 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5363 }
5364 }
5365
5366 void
5367 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5368 {
5369 struct breakpoint *b;
5370
5371 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5372 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5373 {
5374 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5375 update_global_location_list (0);
5376 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5377 }
5378 }
5379
5380 struct breakpoint *
5381 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5382 {
5383 struct breakpoint *b;
5384
5385 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5386
5387 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5388 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
5389 b->addr_string
5390 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5391
5392 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5393
5394 return b;
5395 }
5396
5397 void
5398 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5399 {
5400 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5401
5402 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5403 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5404 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5405 delete_breakpoint (b);
5406 }
5407
5408 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5409 {
5410 char **arg_p;
5411 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5412 char ***addr_string_p;
5413 int *not_found_ptr;
5414 };
5415
5416 struct lang_and_radix
5417 {
5418 enum language lang;
5419 int radix;
5420 };
5421
5422 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
5423
5424 struct breakpoint *
5425 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5426 {
5427 struct breakpoint *b;
5428
5429 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5430 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5431 return b;
5432 }
5433
5434 void
5435 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5436 {
5437 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5438
5439 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5440 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5441 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5442 delete_breakpoint (b);
5443 }
5444
5445 struct breakpoint *
5446 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5447 {
5448 struct breakpoint *b;
5449
5450 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5451 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5452 return b;
5453 }
5454
5455 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
5456 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5457
5458 void
5459 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
5460 {
5461 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5462
5463 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5464 {
5465 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5466 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled
5467 for those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
5468 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to insert
5469 all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here, we'll try
5470 to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
5471 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
5472 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
5473 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5474 || (tracepoint_type (b)))
5475 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
5476 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5477 #ifdef PC_SOLIB
5478 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
5479 #else
5480 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
5481 #endif
5482 )
5483 {
5484 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5485 }
5486 }
5487 }
5488
5489 /* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library. Only
5490 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5491
5492 static void
5493 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
5494 {
5495 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5496 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
5497
5498 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
5499 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
5500 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
5501 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
5502 if (exec_bfd != NULL
5503 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
5504 return;
5505
5506 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5507 {
5508 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5509 if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5510 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
5511 && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
5512 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5513 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
5514 || b->type == bp_jit_event
5515 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5516 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
5517 {
5518 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5519 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
5520 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
5521 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
5522 loc->inserted = 0;
5523 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
5524 {
5525 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5526 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
5527 solib->so_name);
5528 }
5529 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
5530 }
5531 }
5532 }
5533
5534 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
5535
5536 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5537
5538 static void
5539 insert_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5540 {
5541 target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5542 }
5543
5544 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5545
5546 static int
5547 remove_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5548 {
5549 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5550 }
5551
5552 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5553 catchpoints. */
5554
5555 static int
5556 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5557 {
5558 return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5559 }
5560
5561 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5562
5563 static enum print_stop_action
5564 print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5565 {
5566 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5567 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
5568 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5569 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5570 }
5571
5572 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5573
5574 static void
5575 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5576 {
5577 struct value_print_options opts;
5578
5579 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5580
5581 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5582 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5583 is relatively readable). */
5584 if (opts.addressprint)
5585 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5586 annotate_field (5);
5587 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
5588 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5589 {
5590 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5591 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5592 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5593 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5594 }
5595 }
5596
5597 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5598 catchpoints. */
5599
5600 static void
5601 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5602 {
5603 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
5604 }
5605
5606 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
5607
5608 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
5609 {
5610 insert_catch_fork,
5611 remove_catch_fork,
5612 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
5613 print_it_catch_fork,
5614 print_one_catch_fork,
5615 print_mention_catch_fork
5616 };
5617
5618 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5619
5620 static void
5621 insert_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5622 {
5623 target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5624 }
5625
5626 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5627
5628 static int
5629 remove_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5630 {
5631 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5632 }
5633
5634 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5635 catchpoints. */
5636
5637 static int
5638 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5639 {
5640 return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5641 }
5642
5643 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5644
5645 static enum print_stop_action
5646 print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5647 {
5648 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5649 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
5650 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5651 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5652 }
5653
5654 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5655
5656 static void
5657 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5658 {
5659 struct value_print_options opts;
5660
5661 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5662 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5663 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5664 is relatively readable). */
5665 if (opts.addressprint)
5666 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5667 annotate_field (5);
5668 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
5669 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5670 {
5671 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5672 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5673 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5674 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5675 }
5676 }
5677
5678 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5679 catchpoints. */
5680
5681 static void
5682 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5683 {
5684 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
5685 }
5686
5687 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
5688
5689 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
5690 {
5691 insert_catch_vfork,
5692 remove_catch_vfork,
5693 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
5694 print_it_catch_vfork,
5695 print_one_catch_vfork,
5696 print_mention_catch_vfork
5697 };
5698
5699 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5700 catchpoints. */
5701
5702 static void
5703 insert_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5704 {
5705 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5706
5707 ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
5708 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5709 ++inf->any_syscall_count;
5710 else
5711 {
5712 int i, iter;
5713 for (i = 0;
5714 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5715 i++)
5716 {
5717 int elem;
5718 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5719 {
5720 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
5721 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
5722 uintptr_t vec_addr;
5723 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
5724 vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
5725 vec_addr_offset;
5726 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
5727 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
5728 }
5729 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5730 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
5731 }
5732 }
5733
5734 target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5735 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5736 inf->any_syscall_count,
5737 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5738 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5739 }
5740
5741 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5742 catchpoints. */
5743
5744 static int
5745 remove_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5746 {
5747 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5748
5749 --inf->total_syscalls_count;
5750 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5751 --inf->any_syscall_count;
5752 else
5753 {
5754 int i, iter;
5755 for (i = 0;
5756 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5757 i++)
5758 {
5759 int elem;
5760 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5761 /* Shouldn't happen. */
5762 continue;
5763 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5764 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
5765 }
5766 }
5767
5768 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5769 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5770 inf->any_syscall_count,
5771 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5772 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5773 }
5774
5775 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5776 catchpoints. */
5777
5778 static int
5779 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5780 {
5781 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this breakpoint.
5782 If we are, then we must guarantee that the called syscall is the same
5783 syscall we are catching. */
5784 int syscall_number = 0;
5785
5786 if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
5787 return 0;
5788
5789 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
5790 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5791 {
5792 int i, iter;
5793 for (i = 0;
5794 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5795 i++)
5796 if (syscall_number == iter)
5797 break;
5798 /* Not the same. */
5799 if (!iter)
5800 return 0;
5801 }
5802
5803 return 1;
5804 }
5805
5806 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5807 catchpoints. */
5808
5809 static enum print_stop_action
5810 print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5811 {
5812 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
5813 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
5814 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
5815 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
5816 ptid_t ptid;
5817 struct target_waitstatus last;
5818 struct syscall s;
5819 struct cleanup *old_chain;
5820 char *syscall_id;
5821
5822 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
5823
5824 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
5825
5826 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5827
5828 if (s.name == NULL)
5829 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
5830 else
5831 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
5832
5833 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
5834
5835 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
5836 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
5837 b->number, syscall_id);
5838 else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
5839 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
5840 b->number, syscall_id);
5841
5842 do_cleanups (old_chain);
5843
5844 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5845 }
5846
5847 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5848 catchpoints. */
5849
5850 static void
5851 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
5852 struct bp_location **last_loc)
5853 {
5854 struct value_print_options opts;
5855
5856 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5857 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5858 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5859 is relatively readable). */
5860 if (opts.addressprint)
5861 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5862 annotate_field (5);
5863
5864 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
5865 && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5866 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
5867 else
5868 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
5869
5870 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5871 {
5872 int i, iter;
5873 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
5874 for (i = 0;
5875 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5876 i++)
5877 {
5878 char *x = text;
5879 struct syscall s;
5880 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5881
5882 if (s.name != NULL)
5883 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
5884 else
5885 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
5886
5887 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
5888 because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
5889 on every call. */
5890 xfree (x);
5891 }
5892 /* Remove the last comma. */
5893 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
5894 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
5895 }
5896 else
5897 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
5898 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5899 }
5900
5901 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5902 catchpoints. */
5903
5904 static void
5905 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5906 {
5907 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5908 {
5909 int i, iter;
5910
5911 if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5912 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
5913 else
5914 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
5915
5916 for (i = 0;
5917 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5918 i++)
5919 {
5920 struct syscall s;
5921 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5922
5923 if (s.name)
5924 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
5925 else
5926 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
5927 }
5928 printf_filtered (")");
5929 }
5930 else
5931 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
5932 b->number);
5933 }
5934
5935 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
5936
5937 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
5938 {
5939 insert_catch_syscall,
5940 remove_catch_syscall,
5941 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
5942 print_it_catch_syscall,
5943 print_one_catch_syscall,
5944 print_mention_catch_syscall
5945 };
5946
5947 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
5948
5949 static int
5950 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
5951 {
5952 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
5953 }
5954
5955 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
5956 but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
5957 This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
5958 struct breakpoint before calling mention.
5959
5960 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5961 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5962 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5963 to the catchpoint. */
5964
5965 static struct breakpoint *
5966 create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5967 char *cond_string,
5968 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5969 {
5970 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5971 struct breakpoint *b;
5972
5973 init_sal (&sal);
5974 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
5975
5976 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
5977 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
5978 b->number = breakpoint_count;
5979
5980 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
5981 b->thread = -1;
5982 b->addr_string = NULL;
5983 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5984 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
5985 b->ops = ops;
5986
5987 return b;
5988 }
5989
5990 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
5991
5992 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5993 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5994 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5995 to the catchpoint. */
5996
5997 static struct breakpoint *
5998 create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5999 char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6000 {
6001 struct breakpoint *b =
6002 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
6003
6004 mention (b);
6005 update_global_location_list (1);
6006
6007 return b;
6008 }
6009
6010 static void
6011 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6012 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
6013 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6014 {
6015 struct breakpoint *b
6016 = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
6017
6018 /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
6019 area. */
6020 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
6021 }
6022
6023 /* Exec catchpoints. */
6024
6025 static void
6026 insert_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6027 {
6028 target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6029 }
6030
6031 static int
6032 remove_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6033 {
6034 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6035 }
6036
6037 static int
6038 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6039 {
6040 return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
6041 }
6042
6043 static enum print_stop_action
6044 print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6045 {
6046 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
6047 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
6048 b->exec_pathname);
6049 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
6050 }
6051
6052 static void
6053 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
6054 {
6055 struct value_print_options opts;
6056
6057 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6058
6059 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6060 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6061 is relatively readable). */
6062 if (opts.addressprint)
6063 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6064 annotate_field (5);
6065 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
6066 if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
6067 {
6068 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
6069 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
6070 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
6071 }
6072 }
6073
6074 static void
6075 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6076 {
6077 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
6078 }
6079
6080 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
6081 {
6082 insert_catch_exec,
6083 remove_catch_exec,
6084 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
6085 print_it_catch_exec,
6086 print_one_catch_exec,
6087 print_mention_catch_exec
6088 };
6089
6090 static void
6091 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
6092 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6093 {
6094 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
6095 struct breakpoint *b =
6096 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
6097
6098 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
6099
6100 /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
6101 location list. */
6102 mention (b);
6103 update_global_location_list (1);
6104 }
6105
6106 static int
6107 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
6108 {
6109 struct breakpoint *b;
6110 int i = 0;
6111
6112 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6113 {
6114 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6115 i++;
6116 }
6117
6118 return i;
6119 }
6120
6121 static int
6122 hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
6123 {
6124 struct breakpoint *b;
6125 int i = 0;
6126
6127 *other_type_used = 0;
6128 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6129 {
6130 if (breakpoint_enabled (b))
6131 {
6132 if (b->type == type)
6133 i++;
6134 else if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6135 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
6136 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
6137 *other_type_used = 1;
6138 }
6139 }
6140 return i;
6141 }
6142
6143 void
6144 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
6145 {
6146 struct breakpoint *b;
6147
6148 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6149 {
6150 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
6151 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
6152 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
6153 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
6154 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6155 {
6156 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
6157 update_global_location_list (0);
6158 }
6159 }
6160 }
6161
6162 void
6163 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
6164 {
6165 struct breakpoint *b;
6166
6167 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6168 {
6169 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
6170 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
6171 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
6172 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
6173 && (b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled))
6174 {
6175 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6176 update_global_location_list (1);
6177 }
6178 }
6179 }
6180
6181 void
6182 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
6183 {
6184 struct breakpoint *b;
6185 int found = 0;
6186
6187 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6188 {
6189 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6190 continue;
6191
6192 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6193 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6194 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6195 {
6196 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6197 found = 1;
6198 }
6199 }
6200
6201 if (found)
6202 update_global_location_list (0);
6203
6204 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
6205 }
6206
6207 void
6208 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
6209 {
6210 struct breakpoint *b;
6211 int found = 0;
6212
6213 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
6214
6215 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6216 {
6217 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6218 continue;
6219
6220 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6221 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6222 && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
6223 {
6224 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6225 found = 1;
6226 }
6227 }
6228
6229 if (found)
6230 breakpoint_re_set ();
6231 }
6232
6233
6234 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
6235 at address specified by SAL.
6236 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
6237
6238 struct breakpoint *
6239 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
6240 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
6241 {
6242 struct breakpoint *b;
6243
6244 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
6245 one. */
6246 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
6247
6248 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6249 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6250 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6251 b->frame_id = frame_id;
6252
6253 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we
6254 want momentary breakpoints to be active in only a
6255 single thread of control. */
6256 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
6257 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
6258
6259 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
6260
6261 return b;
6262 }
6263
6264 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
6265 ORIG is NULL. */
6266
6267 struct breakpoint *
6268 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
6269 {
6270 struct breakpoint *copy;
6271
6272 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
6273 if (orig == NULL)
6274 return NULL;
6275
6276 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
6277 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
6278 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
6279
6280 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
6281 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
6282 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
6283 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
6284 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
6285
6286 if (orig->source_file == NULL)
6287 copy->source_file = NULL;
6288 else
6289 copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
6290
6291 copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
6292 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
6293 copy->thread = orig->thread;
6294 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
6295
6296 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6297 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6298 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
6299
6300 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
6301 return copy;
6302 }
6303
6304 struct breakpoint *
6305 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
6306 enum bptype type)
6307 {
6308 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6309
6310 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
6311 sal.pc = pc;
6312 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
6313 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6314
6315 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
6316 }
6317 \f
6318
6319 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
6320
6321 static void
6322 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
6323 {
6324 int say_where = 0;
6325 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
6326 struct value_print_options opts;
6327
6328 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6329
6330 /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
6331 hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation. It should
6332 be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
6333 random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook. */
6334 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
6335
6336 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
6337 b->ops->print_mention (b);
6338 else
6339 switch (b->type)
6340 {
6341 case bp_none:
6342 printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "), b->number);
6343 break;
6344 case bp_watchpoint:
6345 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6346 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6347 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6348 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6349 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6350 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6351 break;
6352 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6353 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6354 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6355 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6356 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6357 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6358 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6359 break;
6360 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6361 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6362 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6363 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6364 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6365 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6366 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6367 break;
6368 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6369 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6370 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6371 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6372 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6373 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6374 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6375 break;
6376 case bp_breakpoint:
6377 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6378 {
6379 say_where = 0;
6380 break;
6381 }
6382 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
6383 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
6384 else
6385 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
6386 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6387 say_where = 1;
6388 break;
6389 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6390 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6391 {
6392 say_where = 0;
6393 break;
6394 }
6395 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
6396 say_where = 1;
6397 break;
6398 case bp_tracepoint:
6399 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6400 {
6401 say_where = 0;
6402 break;
6403 }
6404 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
6405 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6406 say_where = 1;
6407 break;
6408 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6409 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6410 {
6411 say_where = 0;
6412 break;
6413 }
6414 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
6415 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6416 say_where = 1;
6417 break;
6418
6419 case bp_until:
6420 case bp_finish:
6421 case bp_longjmp:
6422 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6423 case bp_step_resume:
6424 case bp_call_dummy:
6425 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6426 case bp_shlib_event:
6427 case bp_thread_event:
6428 case bp_overlay_event:
6429 case bp_jit_event:
6430 case bp_longjmp_master:
6431 break;
6432 }
6433
6434 if (say_where)
6435 {
6436 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
6437 single string. */
6438 if (b->loc == NULL)
6439 {
6440 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
6441 }
6442 else
6443 {
6444 if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
6445 {
6446 printf_filtered (" at ");
6447 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
6448 gdb_stdout);
6449 }
6450 if (b->source_file)
6451 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
6452 b->source_file, b->line_number);
6453
6454 if (b->loc->next)
6455 {
6456 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
6457 int n = 0;
6458 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6459 ++n;
6460 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
6461 }
6462
6463 }
6464 }
6465 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6466 return;
6467 printf_filtered ("\n");
6468 }
6469 \f
6470
6471 static struct bp_location *
6472 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6473 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6474 {
6475 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
6476
6477 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
6478 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
6479 ;
6480 *tmp = loc;
6481 loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
6482 if (!loc->gdbarch)
6483 loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
6484 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
6485 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
6486 loc->requested_address, b->type);
6487 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
6488 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
6489 loc->section = sal->section;
6490
6491 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
6492 return loc;
6493 }
6494 \f
6495
6496 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
6497 return 0 otherwise. */
6498
6499 static int
6500 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
6501 {
6502 int len;
6503 CORE_ADDR addr;
6504 const gdb_byte *brk;
6505 gdb_byte *target_mem;
6506 struct cleanup *cleanup;
6507 int retval = 0;
6508
6509 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
6510
6511 addr = loc->address;
6512 brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
6513
6514 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
6515 if (brk == NULL)
6516 return 0;
6517
6518 target_mem = alloca (len);
6519
6520 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
6521 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
6522 breakpoints they are permanent. */
6523 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6524
6525 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
6526 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
6527
6528 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
6529 && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
6530 retval = 1;
6531
6532 do_cleanups (cleanup);
6533
6534 return retval;
6535 }
6536
6537
6538
6539 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
6540 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
6541 as condition expression. */
6542
6543 static void
6544 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6545 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
6546 char *cond_string,
6547 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6548 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6549 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, int enabled)
6550 {
6551 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
6552 int i;
6553
6554 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6555 {
6556 int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
6557 int target_resources_ok =
6558 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
6559 i + 1, 0);
6560 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
6561 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
6562 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
6563 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
6564 }
6565
6566 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
6567
6568 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6569 {
6570 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
6571 struct bp_location *loc;
6572
6573 if (from_tty)
6574 {
6575 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
6576 if (!loc_gdbarch)
6577 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
6578
6579 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
6580 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
6581 }
6582
6583 if (i == 0)
6584 {
6585 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6586 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6587 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6588 b->thread = thread;
6589 b->task = task;
6590
6591 b->cond_string = cond_string;
6592 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6593 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6594 b->disposition = disposition;
6595
6596 b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
6597
6598 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6599 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6600 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6601 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6602
6603 loc = b->loc;
6604 }
6605 else
6606 {
6607 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
6608 }
6609
6610 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
6611 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
6612
6613 if (b->cond_string)
6614 {
6615 char *arg = b->cond_string;
6616 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
6617 if (*arg)
6618 error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
6619 }
6620 }
6621
6622 if (addr_string)
6623 b->addr_string = addr_string;
6624 else
6625 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
6626 me. */
6627 b->addr_string
6628 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
6629
6630 b->ops = ops;
6631 mention (b);
6632 }
6633
6634 /* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
6635 elements to fill the void space. */
6636 static void
6637 remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
6638 {
6639 int i = index_to_remove+1;
6640 int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
6641
6642 for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
6643 sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
6644
6645 --(sal->nelts);
6646 }
6647
6648 /* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
6649 and line as SAL, in all program spaces. Users debugging with IDEs,
6650 will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
6651 about program spaces. This is done only if SAL does not have
6652 explicit PC and has line and file information. If we got just a
6653 single expanded sal, return the original.
6654
6655 Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
6656 which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL. This
6657 makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
6658 instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
6659 the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'. */
6660
6661 static struct symtabs_and_lines
6662 expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
6663 {
6664 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
6665 CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
6666 char *original_function = NULL;
6667 int found;
6668 int i;
6669 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6670
6671 /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
6672 If we have no line number, we can't expand. */
6673 if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
6674 {
6675 expanded.nelts = 1;
6676 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6677 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6678 return expanded;
6679 }
6680
6681 sal.pc = 0;
6682
6683 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6684
6685 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
6686
6687 find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
6688
6689 /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces. */
6690 expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
6691
6692 if (expanded.nelts == 1)
6693 {
6694 /* We had one sal, we got one sal. Return that sal, adjusting it
6695 past the function prologue if necessary. */
6696 xfree (expanded.sals);
6697 expanded.nelts = 1;
6698 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6699 sal.pc = original_pc;
6700 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6701 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
6702 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6703 return expanded;
6704 }
6705
6706 if (!sal.explicit_line)
6707 {
6708 CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
6709 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6710 {
6711 CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
6712 char *this_function;
6713
6714 /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
6715 read memory. */
6716 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
6717
6718 if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
6719 &func_addr, &func_end))
6720 {
6721 if (this_function
6722 && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
6723 {
6724 remove_sal (&expanded, i);
6725 --i;
6726 }
6727 else if (func_addr == pc)
6728 {
6729 /* We're at beginning of a function, and should
6730 skip prologue. */
6731 struct symbol *sym = find_pc_function (pc);
6732 if (sym)
6733 expanded.sals[i] = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6734 else
6735 {
6736 /* Since find_pc_partial_function returned true,
6737 we should really always find the section here. */
6738 struct obj_section *section = find_pc_section (pc);
6739 if (section)
6740 {
6741 struct gdbarch *gdbarch
6742 = get_objfile_arch (section->objfile);
6743 expanded.sals[i].pc
6744 = gdbarch_skip_prologue (gdbarch, pc);
6745 }
6746 }
6747 }
6748 }
6749 }
6750 }
6751 else
6752 {
6753 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6754 {
6755 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a
6756 line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6757 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
6758 }
6759 }
6760
6761 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6762
6763 if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
6764 {
6765 /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero
6766 expanded sals then something is really wrong.
6767 Fix that by returnign the original sal. */
6768 xfree (expanded.sals);
6769 expanded.nelts = 1;
6770 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6771 sal.pc = original_pc;
6772 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6773 return expanded;
6774 }
6775
6776 if (original_pc)
6777 {
6778 found = 0;
6779 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6780 if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
6781 {
6782 found = 1;
6783 break;
6784 }
6785 gdb_assert (found);
6786 }
6787
6788 return expanded;
6789 }
6790
6791 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
6792 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
6793 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
6794 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
6795 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
6796 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
6797 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
6798 we take just a single condition string.
6799
6800 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
6801 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
6802 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
6803 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
6804 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
6805
6806 static void
6807 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6808 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
6809 char *cond_string,
6810 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6811 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6812 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
6813 int enabled)
6814 {
6815 int i;
6816 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6817 {
6818 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
6819 expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
6820
6821 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
6822 cond_string, type, disposition,
6823 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6824 }
6825 }
6826
6827 /* Parse ARG which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
6828 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
6829 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
6830 address strings. ARG points to the end of the SAL. */
6831
6832 static void
6833 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
6834 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6835 char ***addr_string,
6836 int *not_found_ptr)
6837 {
6838 char *addr_start = *address;
6839 *addr_string = NULL;
6840 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
6841 breakpoint. */
6842 if ((*address) == NULL
6843 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
6844 {
6845 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
6846 {
6847 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6848 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
6849 sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
6850 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6851 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
6852 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
6853 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
6854 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
6855 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
6856
6857 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" where PC is
6858 the default_breakpoint_address. So make sure to set
6859 sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to expand the list of
6860 sals to include all other instances with the same symtab and line.
6861 */
6862 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6863
6864 sals->sals[0] = sal;
6865 sals->nelts = 1;
6866 }
6867 else
6868 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
6869 }
6870 else
6871 {
6872 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
6873 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). This
6874 should produce the results we want almost all of the time while
6875 leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
6876 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
6877 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
6878
6879 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
6880
6881 if (default_breakpoint_valid
6882 && (!cursal.symtab
6883 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
6884 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
6885 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
6886 default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
6887 not_found_ptr);
6888 else
6889 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
6890 addr_string, not_found_ptr);
6891 }
6892 /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
6893 if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
6894 *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
6895 if (addr_start != (*address))
6896 {
6897 int i;
6898 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6899 {
6900 /* Add the string if not present. */
6901 if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
6902 (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start, (*address) - addr_start);
6903 }
6904 }
6905 }
6906
6907
6908 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
6909 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
6910
6911 static void
6912 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6913 char *address)
6914 {
6915 int i;
6916 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6917 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
6918 }
6919
6920 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
6921 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
6922 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
6923 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
6924 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
6925 it, etc. */
6926
6927 static void
6928 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6929 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
6930 {
6931 int i, rslt;
6932 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
6933 char *msg;
6934 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6935
6936 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6937 {
6938 sal = &sals->sals[i];
6939
6940 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (gdbarch, sal->pc,
6941 NULL, &msg);
6942 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
6943
6944 if (!rslt)
6945 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
6946 paddress (gdbarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
6947
6948 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6949 }
6950 }
6951
6952 static void
6953 do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
6954 {
6955 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
6956
6957 parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
6958 args->not_found_ptr);
6959 }
6960
6961 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
6962 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
6963 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
6964 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
6965 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
6966 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
6967 static void
6968 find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
6969 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
6970 {
6971 *cond_string = NULL;
6972 *thread = -1;
6973 while (tok && *tok)
6974 {
6975 char *end_tok;
6976 int toklen;
6977 char *cond_start = NULL;
6978 char *cond_end = NULL;
6979 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
6980 tok++;
6981
6982 end_tok = tok;
6983
6984 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
6985 end_tok++;
6986
6987 toklen = end_tok - tok;
6988
6989 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
6990 {
6991 struct expression *expr;
6992
6993 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
6994 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
6995 xfree (expr);
6996 cond_end = tok;
6997 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
6998 cond_end - cond_start);
6999 }
7000 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7001 {
7002 char *tmptok;
7003
7004 tok = end_tok + 1;
7005 tmptok = tok;
7006 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
7007 if (tok == tmptok)
7008 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
7009 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
7010 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
7011 }
7012 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
7013 {
7014 char *tmptok;
7015
7016 tok = end_tok + 1;
7017 tmptok = tok;
7018 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
7019 if (tok == tmptok)
7020 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
7021 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
7022 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
7023 }
7024 else
7025 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7026 }
7027 }
7028
7029 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between CLI and MI
7030 functions for setting a breakpoint. This function has two major
7031 modes of operations, selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD
7032 parameter. If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
7033 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise, ARG is just the
7034 location of breakpoint, with condition and thread specified by the
7035 COND_STRING and THREAD parameters. Returns true if any breakpoint
7036 was created; false otherwise. */
7037
7038 int
7039 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7040 char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
7041 int parse_condition_and_thread,
7042 int tempflag, int hardwareflag, int traceflag,
7043 int ignore_count,
7044 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
7045 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
7046 int from_tty,
7047 int enabled)
7048 {
7049 struct gdb_exception e;
7050 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7051 struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
7052 char *copy_arg;
7053 char *err_msg;
7054 char *addr_start = arg;
7055 char **addr_string;
7056 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7057 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
7058 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
7059 int i;
7060 int pending = 0;
7061 int not_found = 0;
7062 enum bptype type_wanted;
7063 int task = 0;
7064
7065 sals.sals = NULL;
7066 sals.nelts = 0;
7067 addr_string = NULL;
7068
7069 parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
7070 parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
7071 parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
7072 parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
7073
7074 e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
7075 &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
7076
7077 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
7078 switch (e.reason)
7079 {
7080 case RETURN_QUIT:
7081 throw_exception (e);
7082 case RETURN_ERROR:
7083 switch (e.error)
7084 {
7085 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
7086
7087 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
7088 error. */
7089
7090 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
7091 throw_exception (e);
7092
7093 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
7094
7095 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
7096 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
7097 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
7098 && !nquery ("Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? "))
7099 return 0;
7100
7101 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
7102 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
7103 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
7104 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
7105 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
7106 addr_string = &copy_arg;
7107 sals.nelts = 1;
7108 sals.sals = &pending_sal;
7109 pending_sal.pc = 0;
7110 pending = 1;
7111 break;
7112 default:
7113 throw_exception (e);
7114 }
7115 default:
7116 if (!sals.nelts)
7117 return 0;
7118 }
7119
7120 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
7121 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
7122
7123 if (!pending)
7124 {
7125 /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed. */
7126 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
7127
7128 /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
7129 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
7130 }
7131
7132 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
7133 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
7134 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
7135 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
7136 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
7137
7138 /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup. These go on
7139 the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails. */
7140 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
7141 {
7142 if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
7143 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
7144 }
7145
7146 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
7147 are ok for the target. */
7148 if (!pending)
7149 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals, addr_start);
7150
7151 type_wanted = (traceflag
7152 ? (hardwareflag ? bp_fast_tracepoint : bp_tracepoint)
7153 : (hardwareflag ? bp_hardware_breakpoint : bp_breakpoint));
7154
7155 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
7156 if (type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
7157 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &sals);
7158
7159 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
7160 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
7161 breakpoint. */
7162 if (!pending)
7163 {
7164 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
7165 {
7166 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
7167 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
7168 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
7169 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
7170 cond_string = NULL;
7171 thread = -1;
7172 find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
7173 &thread, &task);
7174 if (cond_string)
7175 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
7176 }
7177 else
7178 {
7179 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
7180 if (cond_string)
7181 {
7182 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
7183 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
7184 }
7185 }
7186 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string,
7187 type_wanted, tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
7188 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
7189 enabled);
7190 }
7191 else
7192 {
7193 struct symtab_and_line sal = {0};
7194 struct breakpoint *b;
7195
7196 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
7197
7198 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
7199 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7200 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7201 b->thread = -1;
7202 b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
7203 b->cond_string = NULL;
7204 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
7205 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7206 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
7207 b->ops = ops;
7208 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
7209 b->pspace = current_program_space;
7210
7211 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
7212 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
7213 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
7214 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
7215
7216 mention (b);
7217 }
7218
7219 if (sals.nelts > 1)
7220 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\n"
7221 "Use the \"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
7222 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
7223 breakpoint. */
7224 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
7225 /* But cleanup everything else. */
7226 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7227
7228 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
7229 update_global_location_list (1);
7230
7231 return 1;
7232 }
7233
7234 /* Set a breakpoint.
7235 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
7236 condition, and thread.
7237 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
7238 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
7239 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
7240
7241 static void
7242 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
7243 {
7244 int hardwareflag = flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG;
7245 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
7246
7247 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
7248 arg,
7249 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
7250 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
7251 0 /* Ignore count */,
7252 pending_break_support,
7253 NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
7254 from_tty,
7255 1 /* enabled */);
7256 }
7257
7258
7259
7260 /* Adjust SAL to the first instruction past the function prologue.
7261 The end of the prologue is determined using the line table from
7262 the debugging information. explicit_pc and explicit_line are
7263 not modified.
7264
7265 If SAL is already past the prologue, then do nothing. */
7266
7267 static void
7268 skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7269 {
7270 struct symbol *sym;
7271 struct symtab_and_line start_sal;
7272 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7273
7274 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7275
7276 sym = find_pc_function (sal->pc);
7277 if (sym != NULL)
7278 {
7279 start_sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
7280 if (sal->pc < start_sal.pc)
7281 {
7282 start_sal.explicit_line = sal->explicit_line;
7283 start_sal.explicit_pc = sal->explicit_pc;
7284 *sal = start_sal;
7285 }
7286 }
7287
7288 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7289 }
7290
7291 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
7292
7293 void
7294 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7295 {
7296 CORE_ADDR pc;
7297
7298 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7299 {
7300 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
7301 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
7302 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
7303 sal->pc = pc;
7304
7305 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using
7306 a line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
7307 if (sal->explicit_line)
7308 {
7309 /* Preserve the original line number. */
7310 int saved_line = sal->line;
7311 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
7312 sal->line = saved_line;
7313 }
7314 }
7315
7316 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7317 {
7318 struct blockvector *bv;
7319 struct block *b;
7320 struct symbol *sym;
7321
7322 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
7323 if (bv != NULL)
7324 {
7325 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
7326 if (sym != NULL)
7327 {
7328 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
7329 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
7330 }
7331 else
7332 {
7333 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll just
7334 have to look harder. This case can be executed if we have
7335 line numbers but no functions (as can happen in assembly
7336 source). */
7337
7338 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
7339 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7340
7341 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
7342
7343 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
7344 if (msym)
7345 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
7346
7347 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7348 }
7349 }
7350 }
7351 }
7352
7353 void
7354 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7355 {
7356 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7357 }
7358
7359 void
7360 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7361 {
7362 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
7363 }
7364
7365 static void
7366 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7367 {
7368 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
7369 }
7370
7371 static void
7372 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7373 {
7374 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
7375 }
7376
7377 static void
7378 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7379 {
7380 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
7381 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
7382 stop at <line>\n"));
7383 }
7384
7385 static void
7386 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7387 {
7388 int badInput = 0;
7389
7390 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
7391 badInput = 1;
7392 else if (*arg != '*')
7393 {
7394 char *argptr = arg;
7395 int hasColon = 0;
7396
7397 /* look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
7398 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
7399 function/method name */
7400 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7401 {
7402 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7403 argptr++;
7404 }
7405
7406 if (hasColon)
7407 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
7408 else
7409 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
7410 }
7411
7412 if (badInput)
7413 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
7414 else
7415 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7416 }
7417
7418 static void
7419 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7420 {
7421 int badInput = 0;
7422
7423 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
7424 badInput = 1;
7425 else
7426 {
7427 char *argptr = arg;
7428 int hasColon = 0;
7429
7430 /* look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
7431 it is probably a line number. */
7432 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7433 {
7434 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7435 argptr++;
7436 }
7437
7438 if (hasColon)
7439 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
7440 else
7441 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
7442 }
7443
7444 if (badInput)
7445 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
7446 else
7447 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7448 }
7449
7450 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
7451 hw_read: watch read,
7452 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
7453 static void
7454 watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
7455 {
7456 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7457 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
7458 struct expression *exp;
7459 struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
7460 struct value *val, *mark;
7461 struct frame_info *frame;
7462 char *exp_start = NULL;
7463 char *exp_end = NULL;
7464 char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
7465 int toklen;
7466 char *cond_start = NULL;
7467 char *cond_end = NULL;
7468 int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
7469 enum bptype bp_type;
7470 int mem_cnt = 0;
7471 int thread = -1;
7472
7473 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
7474 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
7475 {
7476 toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list. */
7477
7478 /* Points tok to the end of the argument list. */
7479 tok = arg + toklen - 1;
7480
7481 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last parameter.
7482 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, this should
7483 be the thread identifier. */
7484 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7485 tok--;
7486 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7487 tok--;
7488
7489 /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token. */
7490 id_tok_start = tok + 1;
7491
7492 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more parameter.
7493 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, we should
7494 reach a "thread" token. */
7495 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7496 tok--;
7497
7498 end_tok = tok;
7499
7500 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7501 tok--;
7502
7503 /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
7504 calculate the length of the token. */
7505 tok++;
7506 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7507
7508 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7509 {
7510 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
7511 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
7512 only in a specific thread. */
7513 char *endp;
7514
7515 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
7516 thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
7517
7518 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
7519 thread ID. */
7520 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7521 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
7522
7523 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
7524 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
7525 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
7526
7527 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
7528 parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
7529 evaluate_expression() function. */
7530 *tok = '\0';
7531 }
7532 }
7533
7534 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
7535 innermost_block = NULL;
7536 exp_start = arg;
7537 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
7538 exp_end = arg;
7539 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
7540 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
7541 prettier. */
7542 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
7543 --exp_end;
7544
7545 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7546 mark = value_mark ();
7547 fetch_watchpoint_value (exp, &val, NULL, NULL);
7548 if (val != NULL)
7549 release_value (val);
7550
7551 tok = arg;
7552 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
7553 tok++;
7554 end_tok = tok;
7555
7556 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
7557 end_tok++;
7558
7559 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7560 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7561 {
7562 struct expression *cond;
7563
7564 innermost_block = NULL;
7565 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7566 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
7567
7568 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
7569 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
7570 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7571
7572 xfree (cond);
7573 cond_end = tok;
7574 }
7575 if (*tok)
7576 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
7577
7578 if (accessflag == hw_read)
7579 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
7580 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
7581 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
7582 else
7583 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
7584
7585 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val);
7586 if (mem_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7587 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
7588 if (mem_cnt != 0)
7589 {
7590 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
7591 target_resources_ok =
7592 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + mem_cnt,
7593 other_type_used);
7594 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7595 error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
7596
7597 if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7598 error (_("Target can only support one kind of HW watchpoint at a time."));
7599 }
7600
7601 /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a hardware
7602 watchpoint could not be set. */
7603 if (!mem_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
7604 bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
7605
7606 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
7607
7608 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
7609 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
7610 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
7611 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
7612 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
7613 {
7614 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7615 {
7616 scope_breakpoint
7617 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7618 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
7619 bp_watchpoint_scope);
7620
7621 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7622
7623 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
7624 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
7625
7626 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
7627 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
7628
7629 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
7630 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
7631 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
7632 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
7633 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7634 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
7635 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
7636 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
7637 scope_breakpoint->type);
7638 }
7639 }
7640
7641 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
7642 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
7643 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7644 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7645 b->thread = thread;
7646 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
7647 b->exp = exp;
7648 b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
7649 b->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
7650 b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
7651 b->val = val;
7652 b->val_valid = 1;
7653 if (cond_start)
7654 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
7655 else
7656 b->cond_string = 0;
7657
7658 if (frame)
7659 {
7660 b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
7661 b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
7662 }
7663 else
7664 {
7665 b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
7666 b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
7667 }
7668
7669 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
7670 {
7671 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
7672 need to act on them together. */
7673 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
7674 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
7675 }
7676
7677 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7678
7679 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
7680 that should be inserted. */
7681 update_watchpoint (b, 1);
7682
7683 mention (b);
7684 update_global_location_list (1);
7685 }
7686
7687 /* Return count of locations need to be watched and can be handled
7688 in hardware. If the watchpoint can not be handled
7689 in hardware return zero. */
7690
7691 static int
7692 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
7693 {
7694 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
7695 struct value *head = v;
7696
7697 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
7698 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
7699 return 0;
7700
7701 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
7702 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
7703 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
7704 hardware watchpoint.
7705
7706 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
7707 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
7708 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
7709 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
7710 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
7711 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
7712 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
7713 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
7714 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
7715
7716 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
7717 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
7718 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
7719 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
7720 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
7721 {
7722 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
7723 {
7724 if (value_lazy (v))
7725 /* A lazy memory lvalue is one that GDB never needed to fetch;
7726 we either just used its address (e.g., `a' in `a.b') or
7727 we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' in `a,b'). */
7728 ;
7729 else
7730 {
7731 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
7732 it with hardware watchpoints. */
7733 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
7734
7735 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
7736 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
7737 middle of some value chain. */
7738 if (v == head
7739 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7740 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
7741 {
7742 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
7743 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
7744
7745 if (!target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len))
7746 return 0;
7747 else
7748 found_memory_cnt++;
7749 }
7750 }
7751 }
7752 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
7753 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
7754 return 0; /* ??? What does this represent? */
7755 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
7756 return 0; /* cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint */
7757 }
7758
7759 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
7760 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
7761 return found_memory_cnt;
7762 }
7763
7764 void
7765 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7766 {
7767 watch_command (arg, from_tty);
7768 }
7769
7770 static void
7771 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7772 {
7773 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
7774 }
7775
7776 void
7777 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7778 {
7779 rwatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7780 }
7781
7782 static void
7783 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7784 {
7785 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
7786 }
7787
7788 void
7789 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7790 {
7791 awatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7792 }
7793
7794 static void
7795 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7796 {
7797 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
7798 }
7799 \f
7800
7801 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
7802 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
7803
7804 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
7805 {
7806 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7807 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
7808 };
7809
7810 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
7811 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
7812 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
7813 command. */
7814 static void
7815 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
7816 {
7817 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
7818
7819 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
7820 if (a->breakpoint2)
7821 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
7822 }
7823
7824 void
7825 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
7826 {
7827 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7828 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7829 struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
7830 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7831 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
7832 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7833
7834 clear_proceed_status ();
7835
7836 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
7837 this function */
7838
7839 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7840 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7841 default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7842 else
7843 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
7844 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7845
7846 if (sals.nelts != 1)
7847 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
7848
7849 sal = sals.sals[0];
7850 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed */
7851
7852 if (*arg)
7853 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7854
7855 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
7856
7857 if (anywhere)
7858 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
7859 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
7860 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7861 null_frame_id, bp_until);
7862 else
7863 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only
7864 at the very same frame. */
7865 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7866 get_stack_frame_id (frame),
7867 bp_until);
7868
7869 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
7870
7871 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
7872 one. */
7873
7874 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7875 {
7876 sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
7877 sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7878 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7879 sal,
7880 frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
7881 bp_until);
7882 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
7883 }
7884
7885 proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
7886
7887 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has actually
7888 managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to be
7889 deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already stopped and
7890 delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
7891
7892 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
7893 {
7894 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
7895 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
7896
7897 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
7898 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
7899
7900 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
7901 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
7902 until_break_command_continuation, args,
7903 xfree);
7904 }
7905 else
7906 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7907 }
7908
7909 static void
7910 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s)
7911 {
7912 if ((s == NULL) || (*s == NULL))
7913 return;
7914 while (isspace (**s))
7915 *s += 1;
7916 }
7917
7918 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
7919 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7920
7921 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
7922 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
7923 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
7924 if clause in the arg string. */
7925
7926 static char *
7927 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
7928 {
7929 char *cond_string;
7930
7931 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
7932 return NULL;
7933
7934 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
7935 (*arg) += 2;
7936
7937 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
7938 condition string. */
7939 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (arg);
7940 cond_string = *arg;
7941
7942 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg string. */
7943 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
7944
7945 return cond_string;
7946 }
7947
7948 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
7949 process start/exit, etc. */
7950
7951 typedef enum
7952 {
7953 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
7954 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
7955 }
7956 catch_fork_kind;
7957
7958 static void
7959 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7960 {
7961 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7962 char *cond_string = NULL;
7963 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
7964 int tempflag;
7965
7966 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
7967 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
7968 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
7969
7970 if (!arg)
7971 arg = "";
7972 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7973
7974 /* The allowed syntax is:
7975 catch [v]fork
7976 catch [v]fork if <cond>
7977
7978 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7979 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7980
7981 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7982 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7983
7984 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
7985 and enable reporting of such events. */
7986 switch (fork_kind)
7987 {
7988 case catch_fork_temporary:
7989 case catch_fork_permanent:
7990 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7991 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
7992 break;
7993 case catch_vfork_temporary:
7994 case catch_vfork_permanent:
7995 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7996 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
7997 break;
7998 default:
7999 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
8000 break;
8001 }
8002 }
8003
8004 static void
8005 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8006 {
8007 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8008 int tempflag;
8009 char *cond_string = NULL;
8010
8011 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8012
8013 if (!arg)
8014 arg = "";
8015 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8016
8017 /* The allowed syntax is:
8018 catch exec
8019 catch exec if <cond>
8020
8021 First, check if there's an if clause. */
8022 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
8023
8024 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
8025 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8026
8027 /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
8028 and enable reporting of such events. */
8029 create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
8030 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
8031 }
8032
8033 static enum print_stop_action
8034 print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8035 {
8036 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
8037
8038 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8039
8040 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
8041 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
8042 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
8043 b->loc->address,
8044 b->number, 1);
8045 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
8046 ui_out_text (uiout,
8047 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
8048 : "Catchpoint ");
8049 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8050 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8051 ui_out_text (uiout,
8052 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
8053 : " (exception caught), ");
8054 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8055 {
8056 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8057 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
8058 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8059 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8060 }
8061 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8062 }
8063
8064 static void
8065 print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8066 {
8067 struct value_print_options opts;
8068 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8069 if (opts.addressprint)
8070 {
8071 annotate_field (4);
8072 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
8073 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
8074 else
8075 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
8076 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
8077 }
8078 annotate_field (5);
8079 if (b->loc)
8080 *last_loc = b->loc;
8081 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
8082 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
8083 else
8084 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
8085 }
8086
8087 static void
8088 print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8089 {
8090 int bp_temp;
8091 int bp_throw;
8092
8093 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
8094 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
8095 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
8096 : _("Catchpoint "));
8097 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8098 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
8099 : _(" (catch)"));
8100 }
8101
8102 static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
8103 NULL, /* insert */
8104 NULL, /* remove */
8105 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
8106 print_exception_catchpoint,
8107 print_one_exception_catchpoint,
8108 print_mention_exception_catchpoint
8109 };
8110
8111 static int
8112 handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
8113 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
8114 {
8115 char *trigger_func_name;
8116
8117 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
8118 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
8119 else
8120 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
8121
8122 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
8123 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
8124 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
8125 tempflag, 0, 0,
8126 0,
8127 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
8128 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
8129 1 /* enabled */);
8130
8131 return 1;
8132 }
8133
8134 /* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands */
8135
8136 static void
8137 catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
8138 int tempflag, int from_tty)
8139 {
8140 char *cond_string = NULL;
8141 struct symtab_and_line *sal = NULL;
8142
8143 if (!arg)
8144 arg = "";
8145 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8146
8147 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
8148
8149 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
8150 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8151
8152 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
8153 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
8154 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
8155
8156 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
8157 return;
8158
8159 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
8160 }
8161
8162 /* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
8163
8164 static void
8165 catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8166 {
8167 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8168 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
8169 }
8170
8171 /* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
8172
8173 static void
8174 catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8175 {
8176 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8177 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
8178 }
8179
8180 /* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints. */
8181
8182 static void
8183 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8184 struct symtab_and_line sal,
8185 char *addr_string,
8186 char *exp_string,
8187 char *cond_string,
8188 struct expression *cond,
8189 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8190 int tempflag,
8191 int from_tty)
8192 {
8193 struct breakpoint *b;
8194
8195 if (from_tty)
8196 {
8197 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8198 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8199 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8200
8201 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8202 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
8203 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
8204 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
8205 used for different exception names will use the same address.
8206 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
8207 unproductive. Besides. the warning phrasing is also a bit
8208 inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
8209 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
8210 enough for now, though. */
8211 }
8212
8213 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
8214 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
8215
8216 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8217 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8218 b->number = breakpoint_count;
8219 b->ignore_count = 0;
8220 b->loc->cond = cond;
8221 b->addr_string = addr_string;
8222 b->language = language_ada;
8223 b->cond_string = cond_string;
8224 b->exp_string = exp_string;
8225 b->thread = -1;
8226 b->ops = ops;
8227
8228 mention (b);
8229 update_global_location_list (1);
8230 }
8231
8232 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
8233
8234 static void
8235 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
8236 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8237 {
8238 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8239 int tempflag;
8240 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8241 enum bptype type;
8242 char *addr_string = NULL;
8243 char *exp_string = NULL;
8244 char *cond_string = NULL;
8245 struct expression *cond = NULL;
8246 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8247
8248 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8249
8250 if (!arg)
8251 arg = "";
8252 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
8253 &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
8254 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
8255 cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
8256 from_tty);
8257 }
8258
8259 /* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list. */
8260 static void
8261 clean_up_filters (void *arg)
8262 {
8263 VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
8264 VEC_free (int, iter);
8265 }
8266
8267 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
8268 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
8269 static VEC(int) *
8270 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
8271 {
8272 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
8273 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
8274
8275 while (*arg != '\0')
8276 {
8277 int i, syscall_number;
8278 char *endptr;
8279 char cur_name[128];
8280 struct syscall s;
8281
8282 /* Skip whitespace. */
8283 while (isspace (*arg))
8284 arg++;
8285
8286 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
8287 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
8288 cur_name[i] = '\0';
8289 arg += i;
8290
8291 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
8292 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
8293 if (*endptr == '\0')
8294 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
8295 else
8296 {
8297 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
8298 to a number. */
8299 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
8300
8301 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
8302 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning, because
8303 GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no syscall number to
8304 be caught. */
8305 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
8306 }
8307
8308 /* Ok, it's valid. */
8309 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
8310 }
8311
8312 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8313 return result;
8314 }
8315
8316 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
8317
8318 static void
8319 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8320 {
8321 int tempflag;
8322 VEC(int) *filter;
8323 struct syscall s;
8324 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8325
8326 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
8327 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
8328 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
8329 this architeture yet."));
8330
8331 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8332
8333 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8334
8335 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
8336 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
8337 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
8338 for his/her architecture. */
8339 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
8340
8341 /* The allowed syntax is:
8342 catch syscall
8343 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
8344
8345 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
8346
8347 if (arg != NULL)
8348 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
8349 else
8350 filter = NULL;
8351
8352 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
8353 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8354 }
8355
8356 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
8357
8358 static void
8359 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8360 {
8361 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8362 int tempflag;
8363 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8364 char *addr_string = NULL;
8365 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8366
8367 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8368
8369 if (!arg)
8370 arg = "";
8371 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
8372 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
8373 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
8374 }
8375
8376 static void
8377 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8378 {
8379 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8380 }
8381 \f
8382
8383 static void
8384 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8385 {
8386 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8387 }
8388
8389 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
8390
8391 static void
8392 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8393 {
8394 struct breakpoint *b;
8395 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
8396 int ix;
8397 int default_match;
8398 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8399 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8400 int i;
8401
8402 if (arg)
8403 {
8404 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
8405 default_match = 0;
8406 }
8407 else
8408 {
8409 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
8410 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
8411 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
8412 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
8413 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
8414 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
8415 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
8416 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
8417 if (sal.symtab == 0)
8418 error (_("No source file specified."));
8419
8420 sals.sals[0] = sal;
8421 sals.nelts = 1;
8422
8423 default_match = 1;
8424 }
8425
8426 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not
8427 as bad as it seems, because all existing breakpoints
8428 typically have both file/line and pc set. So, if
8429 clear is given file/line, we can match this to existing
8430 breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
8431
8432 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
8433 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
8434 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
8435 due to optimization, all in one block.
8436 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
8437 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
8438 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
8439 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
8440 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
8441 to support that. */
8442
8443 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond
8444 to it. Do it in two passes, solely to preserve the current
8445 behavior that from_tty is forced true if we delete more than
8446 one breakpoint. */
8447
8448 found = NULL;
8449 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
8450 {
8451 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
8452 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
8453 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
8454 or at default pc.
8455
8456 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
8457
8458 0 1 pc
8459 1 1 pc _and_ line
8460 0 0 line
8461 1 0 <can't happen> */
8462
8463 sal = sals.sals[i];
8464
8465 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to
8466 'found'. */
8467 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8468 {
8469 int match = 0;
8470 /* Are we going to delete b? */
8471 if (b->type != bp_none
8472 && b->type != bp_watchpoint
8473 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
8474 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
8475 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
8476 {
8477 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
8478 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8479 {
8480 int pc_match = sal.pc
8481 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
8482 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
8483 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
8484 || loc->section == sal.section);
8485 int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
8486 && b->source_file != NULL
8487 && sal.symtab != NULL
8488 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
8489 && strcmp (b->source_file, sal.symtab->filename) == 0
8490 && b->line_number == sal.line);
8491 if (pc_match || line_match)
8492 {
8493 match = 1;
8494 break;
8495 }
8496 }
8497 }
8498
8499 if (match)
8500 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
8501 }
8502 }
8503 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
8504 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
8505 {
8506 if (arg)
8507 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
8508 else
8509 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
8510 }
8511
8512 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
8513 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one */
8514 if (from_tty)
8515 {
8516 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
8517 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
8518 else
8519 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
8520 }
8521 breakpoints_changed ();
8522
8523 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
8524 {
8525 if (from_tty)
8526 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
8527 delete_breakpoint (b);
8528 }
8529 if (from_tty)
8530 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
8531 }
8532 \f
8533 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
8534 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
8535 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
8536
8537 void
8538 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
8539 {
8540 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8541
8542 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
8543 if (bs->breakpoint_at
8544 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
8545 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del
8546 && bs->stop)
8547 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner);
8548
8549 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8550 {
8551 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
8552 delete_breakpoint (b);
8553 }
8554 }
8555
8556 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to qsort.
8557 Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what does
8558 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER), secondarily by ordering
8559 first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and terciarily just ensuring the array
8560 is sorted stable way despite qsort being an instable algorithm. */
8561
8562 static int
8563 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
8564 {
8565 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
8566 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
8567 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8568 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8569
8570 if (a->address != b->address)
8571 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
8572
8573 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
8574 if (a_perm != b_perm)
8575 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
8576
8577 /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs. Locations of the same
8578 breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
8579
8580 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
8581 return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
8582 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
8583
8584 return (a > b) - (a < b);
8585 }
8586
8587 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
8588 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current content of
8589 the bp_location array. */
8590
8591 static void
8592 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
8593 {
8594 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
8595
8596 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
8597 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
8598
8599 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
8600 {
8601 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
8602
8603 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
8604 continue;
8605
8606 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
8607 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
8608
8609 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
8610 addr = bl->address - start;
8611 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
8612 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
8613
8614 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
8615
8616 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
8617 addr = end - bl->address;
8618 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
8619 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
8620 }
8621 }
8622
8623 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
8624 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
8625 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
8626 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
8627 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
8628 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
8629 returns true on them.
8630
8631 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
8632 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
8633 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
8634 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
8635 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
8636 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
8637
8638 static void
8639 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
8640 {
8641 struct breakpoint *b;
8642 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
8643 struct cleanup *cleanups;
8644
8645 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
8646 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
8647 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
8648 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
8649 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
8650 once. */
8651 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
8652 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
8653 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
8654 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
8655
8656 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly built
8657 bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
8658 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
8659 unsigned old_location_count;
8660
8661 old_location = bp_location;
8662 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
8663 bp_location = NULL;
8664 bp_location_count = 0;
8665 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
8666
8667 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8668 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8669 bp_location_count++;
8670
8671 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
8672 locp = bp_location;
8673 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8674 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8675 *locp++ = loc;
8676 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
8677 bp_location_compare);
8678
8679 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
8680
8681 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the new
8682 list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not necessary that
8683 those locations should be removed from inferior -- if there's another
8684 location at the same address (previously marked as duplicate),
8685 we don't need to remove/insert the location.
8686
8687 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current and
8688 former bp_location array state respectively. */
8689
8690 locp = bp_location;
8691 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
8692 old_locp++)
8693 {
8694 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
8695 struct bp_location **loc2p;
8696
8697 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations. If not, we
8698 have to free it. */
8699 int found_object = 0;
8700 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
8701 int keep_in_target = 0;
8702 int removed = 0;
8703
8704 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. Stop either
8705 at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
8706 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
8707 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
8708 locp++;
8709
8710 for (loc2p = locp;
8711 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8712 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8713 loc2p++)
8714 {
8715 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
8716 {
8717 found_object = 1;
8718 break;
8719 }
8720 }
8721
8722 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if there's
8723 maybe a new location at the same address. If so, mark that one
8724 inserted, and don't remove this one. This is needed so that we
8725 don't have a time window where a breakpoint at certain location is not
8726 inserted. */
8727
8728 if (old_loc->inserted)
8729 {
8730 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove it. */
8731
8732 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
8733 {
8734 /* The location is still present in the location list, and still
8735 should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
8736 keep_in_target = 1;
8737 }
8738 else
8739 {
8740 /* The location is either no longer present, or got disabled.
8741 See if there's another location at the same address, in which
8742 case we don't need to remove this one from the target. */
8743
8744 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
8745 {
8746 for (loc2p = locp;
8747 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8748 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8749 loc2p++)
8750 {
8751 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
8752
8753 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
8754 {
8755 /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
8756 Duplicates check below will fix up this later. */
8757 loc2->duplicate = 0;
8758
8759 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
8760 access watchpoints, if the former are not
8761 supported, but the latter are. */
8762 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8763 {
8764 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
8765 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
8766 }
8767
8768 if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
8769 {
8770 loc2->inserted = 1;
8771 loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
8772 keep_in_target = 1;
8773 break;
8774 }
8775 }
8776 }
8777 }
8778 }
8779
8780 if (!keep_in_target)
8781 {
8782 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
8783 {
8784 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep this
8785 location on the global list, and try to remove it next
8786 time, but there's no particular reason why we will
8787 succeed next time.
8788
8789 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still valid,
8790 as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint only
8791 after calling us. */
8792 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing breakpoint %d\n"),
8793 old_loc->owner->number);
8794 }
8795 removed = 1;
8796 }
8797 }
8798
8799 if (!found_object)
8800 {
8801 if (removed && non_stop
8802 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
8803 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8804 {
8805 /* This location was removed from the target. In
8806 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
8807 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
8808 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
8809 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
8810 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
8811 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
8812 after we see some number of events. The theory here
8813 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
8814 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
8815 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
8816 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
8817 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
8818 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
8819 SIGTRAP.
8820
8821 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
8822 decr_pc_after_break targets.
8823
8824 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
8825 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
8826 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
8827 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
8828 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
8829 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
8830 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SEGSEGV, or worse, get silently
8831 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
8832 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
8833 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
8834 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
8835 targets that do not support new thread events, like
8836 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
8837 thread_count.
8838
8839 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
8840 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
8841 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
8842 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
8843
8844 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
8845 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
8846 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
8847 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
8848 traps we can no longer explain. */
8849
8850 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
8851 old_loc->owner = NULL;
8852
8853 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
8854 }
8855 else
8856 free_bp_location (old_loc);
8857 }
8858 }
8859
8860 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
8861 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
8862 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
8863 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
8864 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
8865 are sorted first for the same address.
8866
8867 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
8868 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
8869
8870 bp_loc_first = NULL;
8871 wp_loc_first = NULL;
8872 awp_loc_first = NULL;
8873 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
8874 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
8875 {
8876 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
8877 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
8878
8879 if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
8880 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
8881 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
8882 || !loc->enabled
8883 || loc->shlib_disabled
8884 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
8885 || tracepoint_type (b))
8886 continue;
8887
8888 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
8889 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
8890 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8891 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
8892 "actually inserted"));
8893
8894 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8895 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
8896 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
8897 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
8898 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
8899 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
8900 else
8901 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
8902
8903 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
8904 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
8905 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
8906 {
8907 *loc_first_p = loc;
8908 loc->duplicate = 0;
8909 continue;
8910 }
8911
8912 loc->duplicate = 1;
8913
8914 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
8915 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
8916 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8917 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
8918 "a permanent breakpoint"));
8919 }
8920
8921 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
8922 && (have_live_inferiors ()
8923 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
8924 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
8925
8926 do_cleanups (cleanups);
8927 }
8928
8929 void
8930 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
8931 {
8932 struct bp_location *loc;
8933 int ix;
8934
8935 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
8936 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
8937 {
8938 free_bp_location (loc);
8939 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
8940 --ix;
8941 }
8942 }
8943
8944 static void
8945 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
8946 {
8947 struct gdb_exception e;
8948 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8949 update_global_location_list (inserting);
8950 }
8951
8952 /* Clear BPT from a BPS. */
8953 static void
8954 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
8955 {
8956 bpstat bs;
8957 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
8958 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->owner == bpt)
8959 {
8960 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
8961 bs->old_val = NULL;
8962 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
8963 }
8964 }
8965
8966 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
8967 static int
8968 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
8969 {
8970 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
8971 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (th->stop_bpstat, bpt);
8972 return 0;
8973 }
8974
8975 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
8976 structures. */
8977
8978 void
8979 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
8980 {
8981 struct breakpoint *b;
8982 struct bp_location *loc, *next;
8983
8984 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
8985
8986 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because multiple
8987 lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are especial culprits.
8988
8989 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When the
8990 scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of scope, and
8991 delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the scope bp is marked
8992 "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. That bpstat is then
8993 checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are deleted.
8994
8995 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in bp's,
8996 and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing bpstat's, and
8997 teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's storage when no more
8998 references were extent. A cheaper bandaid was chosen. */
8999 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
9000 return;
9001
9002 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting of
9003 breakpoints gets resolved. */
9004 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != NULL)
9005 {
9006 gdb_assert (bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == bpt);
9007 bpt->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
9008 bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
9009 bpt->related_breakpoint = NULL;
9010 }
9011
9012 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
9013
9014 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
9015 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
9016
9017 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9018 if (b->next == bpt)
9019 {
9020 b->next = bpt->next;
9021 break;
9022 }
9023
9024 free_command_lines (&bpt->commands);
9025 xfree (bpt->cond_string);
9026 xfree (bpt->cond_exp);
9027 xfree (bpt->addr_string);
9028 xfree (bpt->exp);
9029 xfree (bpt->exp_string);
9030 value_free (bpt->val);
9031 xfree (bpt->source_file);
9032 xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
9033 clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
9034
9035 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at it after it's been freed. */
9036 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?
9037 We just check stop_bpstat for now. Note that we cannot just
9038 remove bpstats pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list
9039 entirely, as breakpoint commands are associated with the bpstat;
9040 if we remove it here, then the later call to
9041 bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat);
9042 in event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints
9043 with commands won't work. */
9044
9045 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
9046
9047 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint
9048 list, update the global location list. This
9049 will remove locations that used to belong to
9050 this breakpoint. Do this before freeing
9051 the breakpoint itself, since remove_breakpoint
9052 looks at location's owner. It might be better
9053 design to have location completely self-contained,
9054 but it's not the case now. */
9055 update_global_location_list (0);
9056
9057
9058 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this same
9059 bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
9060 bpt->type = bp_none;
9061
9062 xfree (bpt);
9063 }
9064
9065 static void
9066 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
9067 {
9068 delete_breakpoint (b);
9069 }
9070
9071 struct cleanup *
9072 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9073 {
9074 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
9075 }
9076
9077 void
9078 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9079 {
9080 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9081
9082 dont_repeat ();
9083
9084 if (arg == 0)
9085 {
9086 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
9087
9088 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
9089 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
9090 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
9091 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9092 {
9093 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
9094 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
9095 && b->type != bp_jit_event
9096 && b->type != bp_thread_event
9097 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
9098 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
9099 && b->number >= 0)
9100 {
9101 breaks_to_delete = 1;
9102 break;
9103 }
9104 }
9105
9106 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
9107 if (!from_tty
9108 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
9109 {
9110 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9111 {
9112 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
9113 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
9114 && b->type != bp_thread_event
9115 && b->type != bp_jit_event
9116 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
9117 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
9118 && b->number >= 0)
9119 delete_breakpoint (b);
9120 }
9121 }
9122 }
9123 else
9124 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
9125 }
9126
9127 static int
9128 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
9129 {
9130 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
9131 if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
9132 return 0;
9133 return 1;
9134 }
9135
9136 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
9137 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
9138 Null names are ignored. */
9139
9140 static int
9141 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
9142 {
9143 struct bp_location *l;
9144 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
9145 (int (*) (const void *, const void *)) streq,
9146 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
9147
9148 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
9149 {
9150 const char **slot;
9151 const char *name = l->function_name;
9152
9153 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
9154 if (name == NULL)
9155 continue;
9156
9157 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
9158 INSERT);
9159 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never returns
9160 NULL. */
9161 if (*slot != NULL)
9162 {
9163 htab_delete (htab);
9164 return 1;
9165 }
9166 *slot = name;
9167 }
9168
9169 htab_delete (htab);
9170 return 0;
9171 }
9172
9173 static void
9174 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
9175 struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
9176 {
9177 int i;
9178 char *s;
9179 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
9180
9181 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations
9182 are pending, don't do anything. This optimizes
9183 the common case where all locations are in the same
9184 shared library, that was unloaded. We'd like to
9185 retain the location, so that when the library
9186 is loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled
9187 status of the individual locations. */
9188 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
9189 return;
9190
9191 b->loc = NULL;
9192
9193 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
9194 {
9195 struct bp_location *new_loc =
9196 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
9197
9198 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
9199 old symtab. */
9200 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
9201 {
9202 struct gdb_exception e;
9203
9204 s = b->cond_string;
9205 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9206 {
9207 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
9208 0);
9209 }
9210 if (e.reason < 0)
9211 {
9212 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition for breakpoint %d: %s"),
9213 b->number, e.message);
9214 new_loc->enabled = 0;
9215 }
9216 }
9217
9218 if (b->source_file != NULL)
9219 xfree (b->source_file);
9220 if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
9221 b->source_file = NULL;
9222 else
9223 b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
9224
9225 if (b->line_number == 0)
9226 b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
9227 }
9228
9229 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
9230 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9231 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
9232
9233 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing breakpoints. */
9234 {
9235 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
9236 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
9237 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
9238 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
9239 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
9240 often enough until a better solution is found. */
9241 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
9242
9243 for (; e; e = e->next)
9244 {
9245 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
9246 {
9247 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
9248 if (have_ambiguous_names)
9249 {
9250 for (; l; l = l->next)
9251 if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
9252 l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
9253 {
9254 l->enabled = 0;
9255 break;
9256 }
9257 }
9258 else
9259 {
9260 for (; l; l = l->next)
9261 if (l->function_name
9262 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
9263 {
9264 l->enabled = 0;
9265 break;
9266 }
9267 }
9268 }
9269 }
9270 }
9271
9272 update_global_location_list (1);
9273 }
9274
9275
9276 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
9277 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
9278 Unused in this case. */
9279
9280 static int
9281 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
9282 {
9283 /* get past catch_errs */
9284 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
9285 struct value *mark;
9286 int i;
9287 int not_found = 0;
9288 int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
9289 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
9290 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
9291 char *s;
9292 enum enable_state save_enable;
9293 struct gdb_exception e;
9294 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
9295
9296 switch (b->type)
9297 {
9298 case bp_none:
9299 warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9300 b->number);
9301 return 0;
9302 case bp_breakpoint:
9303 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9304 case bp_tracepoint:
9305 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9306 /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup. */
9307 if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
9308 return 0;
9309
9310 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
9311 {
9312 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
9313 delete_breakpoint (b);
9314 return 0;
9315 }
9316
9317 set_language (b->language);
9318 input_radix = b->input_radix;
9319 s = b->addr_string;
9320
9321 save_current_space_and_thread ();
9322 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
9323
9324 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9325 {
9326 sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL,
9327 not_found_ptr);
9328 }
9329 if (e.reason < 0)
9330 {
9331 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
9332 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing
9333 will fail until the right shared library is loaded.
9334 User has already told to create pending breakpoints and
9335 don't need extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
9336 state, then user already saw the message about that breakpoint
9337 being disabled, and don't want to see more errors. */
9338 if (not_found
9339 && (b->condition_not_parsed
9340 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
9341 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
9342 not_found_and_ok = 1;
9343
9344 if (!not_found_and_ok)
9345 {
9346 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
9347 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
9348 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
9349 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
9350 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
9351 which approach is better. */
9352 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9353 throw_exception (e);
9354 }
9355 }
9356
9357 if (!not_found)
9358 {
9359 gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
9360
9361 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
9362 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
9363 {
9364 char *cond_string = 0;
9365 int thread = -1;
9366 int task = 0;
9367
9368 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
9369 &cond_string, &thread, &task);
9370 if (cond_string)
9371 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9372 b->thread = thread;
9373 b->task = task;
9374 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
9375 }
9376
9377 expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
9378 }
9379
9380 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
9381 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
9382 break;
9383
9384 case bp_watchpoint:
9385 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9386 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9387 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9388 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global variables,
9389 or it can be on local variables.
9390
9391 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even persist
9392 across program restarts. Since they can use variables from shared
9393 libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries are loaded
9394 and unloaded.
9395
9396 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
9397 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local and
9398 a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, but
9399 unloading of a shared library will make the expression invalid.
9400 This is not a very common use case, but we still re-evaluate
9401 expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
9402
9403 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
9404 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means
9405 the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
9406 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
9407
9408 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
9409 b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
9410
9411 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
9412 be reevaluated again when enabled. */
9413 update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
9414 break;
9415 /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
9416 that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
9417 loaded. */
9418 case bp_catchpoint:
9419 break;
9420
9421 default:
9422 printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
9423 /* fall through */
9424 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
9425 reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
9426 case bp_overlay_event:
9427 case bp_longjmp_master:
9428 delete_breakpoint (b);
9429 break;
9430
9431 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
9432 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
9433 case bp_shlib_event:
9434
9435 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
9436 Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
9437 case bp_thread_event:
9438
9439 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
9440 over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the breakpoints.
9441 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
9442 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
9443 case bp_until:
9444 case bp_finish:
9445 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
9446 case bp_call_dummy:
9447 case bp_step_resume:
9448 case bp_longjmp:
9449 case bp_longjmp_resume:
9450 case bp_jit_event:
9451 break;
9452 }
9453
9454 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9455 return 0;
9456 }
9457
9458 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
9459 void
9460 breakpoint_re_set (void)
9461 {
9462 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9463 enum language save_language;
9464 int save_input_radix;
9465 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9466
9467 save_language = current_language->la_language;
9468 save_input_radix = input_radix;
9469 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
9470
9471 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9472 {
9473 /* Format possible error msg */
9474 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
9475 b->number);
9476 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
9477 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
9478 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9479 }
9480 set_language (save_language);
9481 input_radix = save_input_radix;
9482
9483 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
9484
9485 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9486
9487 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
9488 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
9489 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
9490 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
9491 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
9492 }
9493 \f
9494 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
9495
9496 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
9497 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
9498 void
9499 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
9500 {
9501 if (b->thread != -1)
9502 {
9503 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
9504 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
9505
9506 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
9507 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
9508 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
9509 as well. */
9510 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
9511 }
9512 }
9513
9514 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9515 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9516 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9517
9518 void
9519 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
9520 {
9521 struct breakpoint *b;
9522
9523 if (count < 0)
9524 count = 0;
9525
9526 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9527 if (b->number == bptnum)
9528 {
9529 b->ignore_count = count;
9530 if (from_tty)
9531 {
9532 if (count == 0)
9533 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time breakpoint %d is reached."),
9534 bptnum);
9535 else if (count == 1)
9536 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
9537 bptnum);
9538 else
9539 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d crossings of breakpoint %d."),
9540 count, bptnum);
9541 }
9542 breakpoints_changed ();
9543 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
9544 return;
9545 }
9546
9547 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
9548 }
9549
9550 void
9551 make_breakpoint_silent (struct breakpoint *b)
9552 {
9553 /* Silence the breakpoint. */
9554 b->silent = 1;
9555 }
9556
9557 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
9558
9559 static void
9560 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9561 {
9562 char *p = args;
9563 int num;
9564
9565 if (p == 0)
9566 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
9567
9568 num = get_number (&p);
9569 if (num == 0)
9570 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
9571 if (*p == 0)
9572 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
9573
9574 set_ignore_count (num,
9575 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
9576 from_tty);
9577 if (from_tty)
9578 printf_filtered ("\n");
9579 }
9580 \f
9581 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
9582 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
9583
9584 static void
9585 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *))
9586 {
9587 char *p = args;
9588 char *p1;
9589 int num;
9590 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
9591 int match;
9592
9593 if (p == 0)
9594 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
9595
9596 while (*p)
9597 {
9598 match = 0;
9599 p1 = p;
9600
9601 num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9602 if (num == 0)
9603 {
9604 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
9605 }
9606 else
9607 {
9608 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
9609 if (b->number == num)
9610 {
9611 struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
9612 match = 1;
9613 function (b);
9614 if (related_breakpoint)
9615 function (related_breakpoint);
9616 break;
9617 }
9618 if (match == 0)
9619 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
9620 }
9621 p = p1;
9622 }
9623 }
9624
9625 static struct bp_location *
9626 find_location_by_number (char *number)
9627 {
9628 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
9629 char *p1;
9630 int bp_num;
9631 int loc_num;
9632 struct breakpoint *b;
9633 struct bp_location *loc;
9634
9635 *dot = '\0';
9636
9637 p1 = number;
9638 bp_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9639 if (bp_num == 0)
9640 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9641
9642 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9643 if (b->number == bp_num)
9644 {
9645 break;
9646 }
9647
9648 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
9649 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9650
9651 p1 = dot+1;
9652 loc_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9653 if (loc_num == 0)
9654 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
9655
9656 --loc_num;
9657 loc = b->loc;
9658 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
9659 ;
9660 if (!loc)
9661 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
9662
9663 return loc;
9664 }
9665
9666
9667 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9668 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9669 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9670
9671 void
9672 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9673 {
9674 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
9675 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
9676 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
9677 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
9678 return;
9679
9680 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
9681 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9682 return;
9683
9684 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9685
9686 update_global_location_list (0);
9687
9688 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9689 }
9690
9691 static void
9692 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9693 {
9694 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9695 if (args == 0)
9696 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9697 switch (bpt->type)
9698 {
9699 case bp_none:
9700 warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9701 bpt->number);
9702 continue;
9703 case bp_breakpoint:
9704 case bp_tracepoint:
9705 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9706 case bp_catchpoint:
9707 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9708 case bp_watchpoint:
9709 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9710 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9711 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9712 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
9713 default:
9714 continue;
9715 }
9716 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9717 {
9718 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9719 if (loc)
9720 loc->enabled = 0;
9721 update_global_location_list (0);
9722 }
9723 else
9724 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, disable_breakpoint);
9725 }
9726
9727 static void
9728 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
9729 {
9730 int target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
9731 struct value *mark;
9732
9733 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9734 {
9735 int i;
9736 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9737 target_resources_ok =
9738 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9739 i + 1, 0);
9740 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9741 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9742 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9743 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9744 }
9745
9746 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint
9747 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9748 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
9749 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9750 {
9751 struct gdb_exception e;
9752
9753 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9754 {
9755 update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
9756 }
9757 if (e.reason < 0)
9758 {
9759 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
9760 bpt->number);
9761 return;
9762 }
9763 }
9764
9765 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9766 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9767 bpt->disposition = disposition;
9768 update_global_location_list (1);
9769 breakpoints_changed ();
9770
9771 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9772 }
9773
9774
9775 void
9776 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9777 {
9778 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
9779 }
9780
9781 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
9782 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
9783 in stopping the inferior. */
9784
9785 static void
9786 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9787 {
9788 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9789 if (args == 0)
9790 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9791 switch (bpt->type)
9792 {
9793 case bp_none:
9794 warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9795 bpt->number);
9796 continue;
9797 case bp_breakpoint:
9798 case bp_tracepoint:
9799 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9800 case bp_catchpoint:
9801 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9802 case bp_watchpoint:
9803 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9804 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9805 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9806 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
9807 default:
9808 continue;
9809 }
9810 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9811 {
9812 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9813 if (loc)
9814 loc->enabled = 1;
9815 update_global_location_list (1);
9816 }
9817 else
9818 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_breakpoint);
9819 }
9820
9821 static void
9822 enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9823 {
9824 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
9825 }
9826
9827 static void
9828 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9829 {
9830 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint);
9831 }
9832
9833 static void
9834 enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9835 {
9836 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
9837 }
9838
9839 static void
9840 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9841 {
9842 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint);
9843 }
9844 \f
9845 static void
9846 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9847 {
9848 }
9849
9850 static void
9851 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9852 {
9853 }
9854
9855 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
9856 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
9857 GDB itself. */
9858
9859 static void
9860 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
9861 const bfd_byte *data)
9862 {
9863 struct breakpoint *bp;
9864
9865 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9866 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
9867 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9868 && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
9869 {
9870 struct bp_location *loc;
9871
9872 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
9873 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
9874 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
9875 && addr + len > loc->address)
9876 {
9877 value_free (bp->val);
9878 bp->val = NULL;
9879 bp->val_valid = 0;
9880 }
9881 }
9882 }
9883
9884 /* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid. */
9885
9886 struct symtabs_and_lines
9887 decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
9888 {
9889 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9890 if (string == 0)
9891 error (_("Empty line specification."));
9892 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
9893 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9894 default_breakpoint_symtab,
9895 default_breakpoint_line,
9896 (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9897 else
9898 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9899 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9900 if (*string)
9901 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
9902 return sals;
9903 }
9904
9905 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
9906 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
9907 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
9908 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
9909 someday. */
9910
9911 void *
9912 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9913 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9914 {
9915 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
9916
9917 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
9918
9919 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
9920 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
9921
9922 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
9923 {
9924 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
9925 xfree (bp_tgt);
9926 return NULL;
9927 }
9928
9929 return bp_tgt;
9930 }
9931
9932 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
9933
9934 int
9935 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
9936 {
9937 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
9938 int ret;
9939
9940 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
9941 xfree (bp_tgt);
9942
9943 return ret;
9944 }
9945
9946 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single stepping. */
9947
9948 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
9949 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
9950
9951 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
9952
9953 void
9954 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9955 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR next_pc)
9956 {
9957 void **bpt_p;
9958
9959 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
9960 {
9961 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
9962 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
9963 }
9964 else
9965 {
9966 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
9967 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
9968 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
9969 }
9970
9971 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would be
9972 to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on the
9973 breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint. We could
9974 adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing this requires
9975 corresponding changes elsewhere where single step breakpoints are
9976 handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
9977
9978 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
9979 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
9980 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
9981 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
9982 }
9983
9984 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
9985
9986 void
9987 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
9988 {
9989 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
9990
9991 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
9992 call. */
9993 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
9994 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
9995 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
9996 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
9997
9998 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
9999 {
10000 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
10001 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
10002 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
10003 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
10004 }
10005 }
10006
10007 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at PC. */
10008
10009 static int
10010 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
10011 {
10012 int i;
10013
10014 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
10015 {
10016 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
10017 if (bp_tgt
10018 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
10019 bp_tgt->placed_address,
10020 aspace, pc))
10021 return 1;
10022 }
10023
10024 return 0;
10025 }
10026
10027 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
10028 non-zero otherwise. */
10029 static int
10030 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
10031 {
10032 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
10033 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
10034 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
10035 return 1;
10036 else
10037 return 0;
10038 }
10039
10040 int
10041 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
10042 {
10043 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
10044
10045 return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
10046 }
10047
10048 int
10049 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
10050 {
10051 struct breakpoint *bp;
10052
10053 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
10054 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
10055 {
10056 if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
10057 {
10058 int i, iter;
10059 for (i = 0;
10060 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
10061 i++)
10062 if (syscall_number == iter)
10063 return 1;
10064 }
10065 else
10066 return 1;
10067 }
10068
10069 return 0;
10070 }
10071
10072 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
10073 static char **
10074 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
10075 char *text, char *word)
10076 {
10077 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
10078 return (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
10079 }
10080
10081 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
10082
10083 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
10084 static void
10085 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
10086 {
10087 tracepoint_count = num;
10088 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
10089 }
10090
10091 void
10092 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10093 {
10094 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10095 arg,
10096 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
10097 0 /* tempflag */, 0 /* hardwareflag */,
10098 1 /* traceflag */,
10099 0 /* Ignore count */,
10100 pending_break_support,
10101 NULL,
10102 from_tty,
10103 1 /* enabled */))
10104 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10105 }
10106
10107 void
10108 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10109 {
10110 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10111 arg,
10112 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
10113 0 /* tempflag */, 1 /* hardwareflag */,
10114 1 /* traceflag */,
10115 0 /* Ignore count */,
10116 pending_break_support,
10117 NULL,
10118 from_tty,
10119 1 /* enabled */))
10120 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10121 }
10122
10123 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
10124 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
10125 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
10126 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
10127 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
10128
10129 struct breakpoint *
10130 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
10131 {
10132 char buf[100];
10133 struct breakpoint *tp;
10134
10135 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw address. */
10136 sprintf (buf, "*%s", paddress (get_current_arch(), utp->addr));
10137
10138 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10139 buf,
10140 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
10141 0 /* tempflag */,
10142 (utp->type == bp_fast_tracepoint) /* hardwareflag */,
10143 1 /* traceflag */,
10144 0 /* Ignore count */,
10145 pending_break_support,
10146 NULL,
10147 0 /* from_tty */,
10148 utp->enabled /* enabled */))
10149 return NULL;
10150
10151 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10152
10153 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
10154 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
10155
10156 if (utp->pass > 0)
10157 {
10158 sprintf (buf, "%d %d", utp->pass, tp->number);
10159
10160 trace_pass_command (buf, 0);
10161 }
10162
10163 if (utp->cond)
10164 {
10165 printf_filtered ("Want to restore a condition\n");
10166 }
10167
10168 if (utp->numactions > 0)
10169 {
10170 printf_filtered ("Want to restore action list\n");
10171 }
10172
10173 if (utp->num_step_actions > 0)
10174 {
10175 printf_filtered ("Want to restore action list\n");
10176 }
10177
10178 return tp;
10179 }
10180
10181 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
10182 omitted. */
10183
10184 static void
10185 tracepoints_info (char *tpnum_exp, int from_tty)
10186 {
10187 struct breakpoint *b;
10188 int tps_to_list = 0;
10189
10190 /* In the no-arguments case, say "No tracepoints" if none found. */
10191 if (tpnum_exp == 0)
10192 {
10193 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
10194 {
10195 if (b->number >= 0)
10196 {
10197 tps_to_list = 1;
10198 break;
10199 }
10200 }
10201 if (!tps_to_list)
10202 {
10203 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
10204 return;
10205 }
10206 }
10207
10208 /* Otherwise be the same as "info break". */
10209 breakpoints_info (tpnum_exp, from_tty);
10210 }
10211
10212 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
10213 Not supported by all targets. */
10214 static void
10215 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10216 {
10217 enable_command (args, from_tty);
10218 }
10219
10220 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
10221 Not supported by all targets. */
10222 static void
10223 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10224 {
10225 disable_command (args, from_tty);
10226 }
10227
10228 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument) */
10229 static void
10230 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10231 {
10232 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
10233
10234 dont_repeat ();
10235
10236 if (arg == 0)
10237 {
10238 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
10239
10240 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
10241 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
10242 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
10243 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
10244 {
10245 if (b->number >= 0)
10246 {
10247 breaks_to_delete = 1;
10248 break;
10249 }
10250 }
10251
10252 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
10253 if (!from_tty
10254 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
10255 {
10256 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
10257 {
10258 if (tracepoint_type (b)
10259 && b->number >= 0)
10260 delete_breakpoint (b);
10261 }
10262 }
10263 }
10264 else
10265 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
10266 }
10267
10268 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
10269
10270 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
10271 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
10272 Also accepts special argument "all". */
10273
10274 static void
10275 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10276 {
10277 struct breakpoint *t1 = (struct breakpoint *) -1, *t2;
10278 unsigned int count;
10279 int all = 0;
10280
10281 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
10282 error (_("passcount command requires an argument (count + optional TP num)"));
10283
10284 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
10285
10286 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
10287 args++;
10288
10289 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
10290 {
10291 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
10292 all = 1;
10293 if (*args)
10294 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
10295 }
10296 else
10297 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 1);
10298
10299 do
10300 {
10301 if (t1)
10302 {
10303 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t2)
10304 if (t1 == (struct breakpoint *) -1 || t1 == t2)
10305 {
10306 t2->pass_count = count;
10307 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (t2->number);
10308 if (from_tty)
10309 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
10310 t2->number, count);
10311 }
10312 if (! all && *args)
10313 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 0);
10314 }
10315 }
10316 while (*args);
10317 }
10318
10319 struct breakpoint *
10320 get_tracepoint (int num)
10321 {
10322 struct breakpoint *t;
10323
10324 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10325 if (t->number == num)
10326 return t;
10327
10328 return NULL;
10329 }
10330
10331 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
10332 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
10333 reconnecting). */
10334
10335 struct breakpoint *
10336 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
10337 {
10338 struct breakpoint *t;
10339
10340 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10341 if (t->number_on_target == num)
10342 return t;
10343
10344 return NULL;
10345 }
10346
10347 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
10348 If MULTI_P is true, there might be a range of tracepoints in ARG.
10349 if OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
10350 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
10351 struct breakpoint *
10352 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, int multi_p, int optional_p)
10353 {
10354 extern int tracepoint_count;
10355 struct breakpoint *t;
10356 int tpnum;
10357 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
10358
10359 if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
10360 {
10361 if (optional_p)
10362 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
10363 else
10364 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
10365 }
10366 else
10367 tpnum = multi_p ? get_number_or_range (arg) : get_number (arg);
10368
10369 if (tpnum <= 0)
10370 {
10371 if (instring && *instring)
10372 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
10373 instring);
10374 else
10375 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing and no previous tracepoint\n"));
10376 return NULL;
10377 }
10378
10379 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10380 if (t->number == tpnum)
10381 {
10382 return t;
10383 }
10384
10385 /* FIXME: if we are in the middle of a range we don't want to give
10386 a message. The current interface to get_number_or_range doesn't
10387 allow us to discover this. */
10388 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
10389 return NULL;
10390 }
10391
10392 /* save-tracepoints command */
10393 static void
10394 tracepoint_save_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10395 {
10396 struct breakpoint *tp;
10397 int any_tp = 0;
10398 struct command_line *line;
10399 char *pathname;
10400 char tmp[40];
10401 struct cleanup *cleanup;
10402 struct ui_file *fp;
10403
10404 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
10405 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save tracepoints)"));
10406
10407 /* See if we have anything to save. */
10408 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10409 {
10410 any_tp = 1;
10411 break;
10412 }
10413 if (!any_tp)
10414 {
10415 warning (_("save-tracepoints: no tracepoints to save."));
10416 return;
10417 }
10418
10419 pathname = tilde_expand (args);
10420 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
10421 fp = gdb_fopen (pathname, "w");
10422 if (!fp)
10423 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving tracepoints (%s)"),
10424 args, safe_strerror (errno));
10425 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (fp);
10426
10427 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10428 {
10429 if (tp->addr_string)
10430 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace %s\n", tp->addr_string);
10431 else
10432 {
10433 sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
10434 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace *0x%s\n", tmp);
10435 }
10436
10437 if (tp->pass_count)
10438 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
10439
10440 if (tp->commands)
10441 {
10442 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
10443
10444 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " actions\n");
10445
10446 ui_out_redirect (uiout, fp);
10447 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
10448 {
10449 print_command_lines (uiout, tp->commands, 2);
10450 }
10451 ui_out_redirect (uiout, NULL);
10452
10453 if (ex.reason < 0)
10454 throw_exception (ex);
10455
10456 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " end\n");
10457 }
10458 }
10459 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10460 if (from_tty)
10461 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoints saved to file '%s'.\n"), args);
10462 return;
10463 }
10464
10465 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
10466
10467 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
10468 all_tracepoints ()
10469 {
10470 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
10471 struct breakpoint *tp;
10472
10473 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10474 {
10475 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
10476 }
10477
10478 return tp_vec;
10479 }
10480
10481 \f
10482 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak commands.
10483 It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
10484 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the command. */
10485 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
10486 command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
10487 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10488 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
10489 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
10490 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
10491 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of selected stack frame.\n\
10492 This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
10493 \n\
10494 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
10495 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
10496 \n\
10497 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if conditional.\n\
10498 \n\
10499 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
10500
10501 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
10502 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
10503
10504 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
10505 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
10506
10507 /* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
10508 lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function. */
10509 static void
10510 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
10511 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
10512 struct cmd_list_element *command),
10513 char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
10514 char *text, char *word),
10515 void *user_data_catch,
10516 void *user_data_tcatch)
10517 {
10518 struct cmd_list_element *command;
10519
10520 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10521 &catch_cmdlist);
10522 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10523 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
10524 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10525
10526 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10527 &tcatch_cmdlist);
10528 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10529 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
10530 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10531 }
10532
10533 static void
10534 clear_syscall_counts (struct inferior *inf)
10535 {
10536 inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
10537 inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
10538 VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
10539 }
10540
10541 void
10542 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
10543 {
10544 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
10545 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
10546 struct cmd_list_element *c;
10547
10548 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
10549 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
10550 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
10551
10552 breakpoint_chain = 0;
10553 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
10554 before a breakpoint is set. */
10555 breakpoint_count = 0;
10556
10557 tracepoint_count = 0;
10558
10559 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
10560 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
10561 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
10562 if (xdb_commands)
10563 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
10564
10565 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
10566 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
10567 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
10568 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
10569 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
10570 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
10571 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
10572 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
10573
10574 add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
10575 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
10576 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
10577 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
10578
10579 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
10580 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
10581 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10582 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
10583 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
10584 \n"
10585 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
10586 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10587
10588 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
10589 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10590 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
10591 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
10592 \n"
10593 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
10594 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10595
10596 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
10597 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10598 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10599 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
10600 \n"
10601 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
10602 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10603
10604 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10605 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10606 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10607 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10608 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10609 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
10610 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10611 if (xdb_commands)
10612 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10613 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10614 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10615 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10616 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10617 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
10618
10619 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10620
10621 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10622 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10623 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10624 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10625 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
10626 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
10627
10628 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10629 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10630 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10631 &enablebreaklist);
10632
10633 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10634 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10635 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10636 &enablebreaklist);
10637
10638 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10639 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10640 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10641 &enablelist);
10642
10643 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10644 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10645 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10646 &enablelist);
10647
10648 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10649 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10650 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10651 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10652 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
10653 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10654 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10655 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10656 if (xdb_commands)
10657 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10658 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10659 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10660 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10661 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
10662
10663 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
10664 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10665 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10666 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10667 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
10668 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
10669 &disablelist);
10670
10671 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10672 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10673 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10674 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10675 \n\
10676 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
10677 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
10678 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
10679 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10680 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10681 if (xdb_commands)
10682 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10683 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
10684 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10685 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
10686
10687 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
10688 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10689 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10690 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10691 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
10692 &deletelist);
10693
10694 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
10695 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
10696 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10697 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
10698 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
10699 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
10700 \n\
10701 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
10702 is executing in.\n\
10703 \n\
10704 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
10705
10706 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
10707 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
10708 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
10709 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10710
10711 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
10712 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
10713 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
10714 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
10715
10716 if (xdb_commands)
10717 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
10718
10719 if (dbx_commands)
10720 {
10721 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
10722 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
10723 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
10724 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
10725 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
10726 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
10727 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
10728 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
10729 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10730 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10731 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10732 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10733 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10734 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10735 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10736 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10737 \n\
10738 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10739 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10740 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10741 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10742 breakpoint set."));
10743 }
10744
10745 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
10746 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10747 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10748 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10749 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10750 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10751 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10752 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10753 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10754 \n\
10755 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10756 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10757 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10758 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10759 breakpoint set."));
10760
10761 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
10762
10763 if (xdb_commands)
10764 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
10765 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10766 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10767 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10768 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10769 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10770 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10771 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10772 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10773 \n\
10774 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10775 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10776 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10777 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10778 breakpoint set."));
10779
10780 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
10781 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10782 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10783 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10784 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10785 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
10786 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
10787 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
10788 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
10789 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10790 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10791 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10792 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10793 \n\
10794 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10795 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10796 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10797 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10798 breakpoint set."),
10799 &maintenanceinfolist);
10800
10801 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
10802 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
10803 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
10804 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10805
10806 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
10807 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
10808 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
10809 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10810
10811 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
10812 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
10813 Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
10814 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10815 catch_catch_command,
10816 NULL,
10817 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10818 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10819 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
10820 Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
10821 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10822 catch_throw_command,
10823 NULL,
10824 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10825 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10826 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
10827 catch_fork_command_1,
10828 NULL,
10829 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
10830 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
10831 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
10832 catch_fork_command_1,
10833 NULL,
10834 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
10835 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
10836 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
10837 catch_exec_command_1,
10838 NULL,
10839 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10840 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10841 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
10842 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
10843 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
10844 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
10845 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
10846 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
10847 catch_syscall_command_1,
10848 catch_syscall_completer,
10849 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10850 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10851 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
10852 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
10853 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10854 catch_ada_exception_command,
10855 NULL,
10856 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10857 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10858 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
10859 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
10860 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10861 catch_assert_command,
10862 NULL,
10863 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10864 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10865
10866 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
10867 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10868 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10869 an expression changes."));
10870 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10871
10872 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
10873 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10874 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10875 an expression is read."));
10876 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10877
10878 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
10879 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10880 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10881 an expression is either read or written."));
10882 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10883
10884 add_info ("watchpoints", breakpoints_info,
10885 _("Synonym for ``info breakpoints''."));
10886
10887
10888 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
10889 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
10890 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
10891 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
10892 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10893 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10894 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
10895 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
10896 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
10897 hardware.)"),
10898 NULL,
10899 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
10900 &setlist, &showlist);
10901
10902 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
10903
10904 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
10905
10906 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
10907 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10908 \n"
10909 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
10910 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10911 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10912
10913 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
10914 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10915 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10916 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10917
10918 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
10919 Set a fast tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10920 \n"
10921 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
10922 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10923 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10924
10925 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
10926 Status of tracepoints, or tracepoint number NUMBER.\n\
10927 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
10928 last tracepoint set."));
10929
10930 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
10931
10932 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
10933 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
10934 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10935 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
10936 &deletelist);
10937
10938 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
10939 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
10940 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10941 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
10942 &disablelist);
10943 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
10944
10945 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
10946 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
10947 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10948 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
10949 &enablelist);
10950 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
10951
10952 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
10953 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
10954 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
10955 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
10956 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
10957
10958 c = add_com ("save-tracepoints", class_trace, tracepoint_save_command, _("\
10959 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
10960 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."));
10961 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
10962
10963 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10964 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10965 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10966 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10967 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
10968 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
10969 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10970 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10971 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10972 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10973 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
10974 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
10975
10976 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
10977 &pending_break_support, _("\
10978 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10979 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10980 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
10981 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
10982 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
10983 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
10984 NULL,
10985 show_pending_break_support,
10986 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10987 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10988
10989 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
10990
10991 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
10992 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
10993 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10994 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10995 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
10996 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
10997 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
10998 NULL,
10999 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
11000 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
11001 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
11002
11003 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
11004 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
11005 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
11006 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
11007 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
11008 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
11009 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
11010 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
11011 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
11012 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
11013 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
11014 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
11015 NULL,
11016 &show_always_inserted_mode,
11017 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
11018 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
11019
11020 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
11021
11022 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
11023 }